1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
3 @c Note: This document requires makeinfo version 4.6 or greater to build.
6 @setfilename ../info/mh-e
7 @settitle The MH-E Manual
10 @c Version of the software and manual.
12 @c Edition of the manual. It is either empty for the first edition or
13 @c has the form ", nth Edition" (without the quotes).
15 @set UPDATED 2006-11-12
16 @set UPDATE-MONTH November, 2006
19 @set MH-BOOK-HOME http://rand-mh.sourceforge.net/book/mh
20 @set MH-E-HOME http://mh-e.sourceforge.net/
24 This is version @value{VERSION}@value{EDITION} of @cite{The MH-E
25 Manual}, last updated @value{UPDATED}.
27 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free
28 Software Foundation, Inc.
31 The MH-E manual is free documentation; you can redistribute it and/or
32 modify it under the terms of either:
36 the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version
37 published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections,
38 no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts.
41 the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
42 Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later version.
45 The MH-E manual is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
46 WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
47 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
48 General Public License or GNU Free Documentation License for more
51 The GNU General Public License and the GNU Free Documentation License
52 appear as appendices to this document. You may also request copies by
53 writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street,
54 Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
58 @c Info Directory Entry
61 * MH-E: (mh-e). Emacs interface to the MH mail system.
65 @setchapternewpage odd
67 @title The MH-E Manual
68 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}@value{EDITION}
69 @subtitle @value{UPDATE-MONTH}
74 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
82 @node Top, Preface, (dir), (dir)
99 * Conventions:: GNU Emacs Terms and Conventions
100 * Getting Started:: Getting Started
101 * Tour Through MH-E:: Tour Through MH-E
102 * Using This Manual:: Using This Manual
103 * Incorporating Mail:: Incorporating Mail
104 * Reading Mail:: Reading Mail
105 * Folders:: Organizing Your Mail with Folders
106 * Sending Mail:: Sending Mail
107 * Editing Drafts:: Editing a Draft
109 * Identities:: Identities
110 * Speedbar:: The Speedbar
111 * Menu Bar:: The Menu Bar
112 * Tool Bar:: The Tool Bar
113 * Searching:: Searching Through Messages
114 * Threading:: Viewing Message Threads
115 * Limits:: Limiting Display
116 * Sequences:: Using Sequences
117 * Junk:: Dealing With Junk Mail
118 * Miscellaneous:: Miscellaneous Commands, Variables, and Buffers
119 * Scan Line Formats:: Scan Line Formats
120 * Procmail:: Reading Mailing Lists Effectively
121 * Odds and Ends:: Odds and Ends
122 * History:: History of MH-E
123 * GFDL:: GNU Free Documentation License
124 * GPL:: GNU Public License
125 * Key Index:: Key (Character) Index
126 * Command Index:: Command Index
127 * Option Index:: Option (Variable) Index
128 * Concept Index:: Concept Index
131 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
135 * Sending Mail Tour::
136 * Reading Mail Tour::
137 * Processing Mail Tour::
150 * Viewing Attachments::
157 * Miscellaneous Commands and Options::
171 * Inserting Messages::
174 * Adding Attachments::
176 * Checking Recipients::
184 * MH FAQ and Support::
191 * From Stephen Gildea::
201 @node Preface, Conventions, Top, Top
205 @cindex Unix commands, Emacs
208 This manual introduces another interface to the MH mail system that is
209 accessible through the GNU Emacs editor, namely, @emph{MH-E}. MH-E is
210 easy to use. I don't assume that you know GNU Emacs or even MH at this
211 point, since I didn't know either of them when I discovered MH-E.
212 However, MH-E was the tip of the iceberg, and I discovered more and
213 more niceties about GNU Emacs and MH@. Now I'm fully hooked on both of
216 The MH-E package is distributed with GNU Emacs@footnote{Version
217 @value{VERSION} of MH-E will appear in GNU Emacs 22.1. It is supported
218 in GNU Emacs 21, as well as XEmacs 21 (except for versions
219 21.5.9-21.5.16). It is compatible with MH versions 6.8.4 and higher,
220 all versions of nmh, and GNU mailutils 1.0 and higher.}, so you
221 shouldn't have to do anything special to use it. This manual covers
222 MH-E version @value{VERSION}. To help you decide which version you
223 have, see @ref{Getting Started}.
225 @findex help-with-tutorial
228 If you don't already use GNU Emacs but want to learn more, you can
229 read an online tutorial by starting GNU Emacs and typing @kbd{C-h t}
230 (@code{help-with-tutorial}). (To learn about this notation, see
231 @ref{Conventions}.) If you want to take the plunge, consult the
233 @cite{GNU Emacs Manual},
236 @ref{top, , GNU Emacs Manual, emacs, GNU Emacs Manual},
239 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/,
240 @cite{GNU Emacs Manual}},
242 from the Free Software Foundation.
244 If more information is needed, you can go to the Unix manual pages of
245 the individual MH commands. When the name is not obvious, I'll guide
246 you to a relevant MH manual page that describes the action more fully.
248 @cindex @cite{MH & nmh: Email for Users & Programmers}
253 This manual is available in both Info and online formats. The Info
254 version is distributed with Emacs and can be accessed with the
255 @command{info} command (@samp{info mh-e}) or within Emacs (@kbd{C-h i
256 m mh-e @key{RET}}). The online version is available at
257 @uref{http://mh-e.sourceforge.net/manual/, SourceForge}. Another great
258 online resource is the book @uref{http://www.ics.uci.edu/~mh/book/,
259 @cite{MH & nmh: Email for Users & Programmers}} (also known as
262 I hope you enjoy this manual! If you have any comments, or suggestions
263 for this document, please let me know.
269 Bill Wohler <@i{wohler at newt.com}>@*
273 @node Conventions, Getting Started, Preface, Top
274 @chapter GNU Emacs Terms and Conventions
277 @cindex Emacs, conventions
279 @cindex Unix commands, Emacs
280 @cindex conventions, Emacs
283 If you're an experienced Emacs user, you can skip the following
284 conventions and definition of terms and go directly to the next
285 section (@pxref{Getting Started}).
287 @cindex Emacs commands
289 @cindex Unix commands
292 @cindex commands, Unix
293 @cindex commands, shell
295 @cindex shell commands
297 In general, @dfn{functions} in this text refer to Emacs Lisp functions
298 that one would call from within Emacs Lisp programs (for example,
299 @code{(mh-inc-folder)}). On the other hand, @dfn{commands} are those
300 things that are run by the user, such as @kbd{i} or @kbd{M-x
301 mh-inc-folder}. Programs outside of Emacs are specifically called MH
302 commands, shell commands, or Unix commands.
304 @cindex conventions, key names
307 The conventions for key names are as follows:
311 Hold down the @key{CTRL} (Control) key and press the @kbd{x} key.
312 @c -------------------------
314 Hold down the @key{META} or @key{ALT} key and press the @kbd{x} key.
316 Since some keyboards don't have a @key{META} key, you can generate
317 @kbd{M-x}, for example, by pressing @key{ESC} (Escape),
318 @emph{releasing it}, and then pressing the @kbd{x} key.
319 @c -------------------------
321 Press the @key{RETURN} or @key{ENTER} key. This is normally used to
323 @c -------------------------
326 @c -------------------------
328 Press the @key{TAB} key.
329 @c -------------------------
331 Press the @key{DELETE} key.
332 @c -------------------------
334 Press the @key{BACKSPACE} key@footnote{If you are using Version 20 or
335 earlier of Emacs, you will need to use the @key{DEL} key.}.
338 @cindex Emacs, prefix argument
339 @cindex prefix argument
342 A @dfn{prefix argument} allows you to pass an argument to any Emacs
343 function. To pass an argument, type @kbd{C-u} before the Emacs command
344 or keystroke. Numeric arguments can be passed as well. For example, to
345 insert five f's, use @kbd{C-u 5 f}. There is a default of four when
346 using @kbd{C-u}, and you can use multiple prefix arguments to provide
347 arguments of powers of four. To continue our example, you could insert
348 four f's with @kbd{C-u f}, 16 f's with @kbd{C-u C-u f}, 64 f's with
349 @kbd{C-u C-u C-u f}, and so on. Numeric and valueless negative
350 arguments can also be inserted with the @key{META} key. Examples
351 include @kbd{M-5} to specify an argument of 5, or @kbd{M--} which
352 specifies a negative argument with no particular value.
355 @center @strong{NOTE}
358 The prefix @kbd{C-u} or @kbd{M-} is not necessary in MH-E's MH-Folder
359 mode (@pxref{Reading Mail Tour}). In this mode, simply enter the
360 numerical argument before entering the command.
364 @cindex @file{.emacs}
365 @cindex Emacs, variables
366 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
370 Emacs uses @dfn{variables} to hold values. These can be changed via
371 calls to the function @code{setq} in @file{~/.emacs}.
373 @cindex Emacs, options
375 @findex customize-group
376 @findex customize-option
378 Variables in MH-E that are normally modified by the user are called
379 @dfn{options} and are modified through the customize functions (such
380 as @kbd{M-x customize-option} or @kbd{M-x customize-group}).
382 @xref{Easy Customization,,,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}, in @cite{The
387 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Easy-Customization.html,
388 Easy Customization} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
395 @findex customize-face
397 You can specify various styles for displaying text using @dfn{faces}.
398 MH-E provides a set of faces that you can use to personalize the look
399 of your MH-E buffers. Use the command @kbd{M-x customize-face} to do
402 @xref{Face Customization,,,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}, in @cite{The
407 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Face-Customization.html,
408 Face Customization} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
411 @cindex abnormal hooks
415 @findex customize-option
417 Commands often offer @dfn{hooks} which enable you to extend or modify
418 the way a command works.
420 @ref{Hooks, , Hooks, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, in @cite{The GNU
425 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Hooks.html,
426 Hooks} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}
428 for a description about @dfn{normal hooks} and @dfn{abnormal hooks}.
429 MH-E uses normal hooks in nearly all cases, so you can assume that we
430 are talking about normal hooks unless we explicitly mention that a
431 hook is abnormal. We also follow the conventions described in that
432 section: the name of the abnormal hooks end in @code{-hooks} and all
433 the rest of the MH-E hooks end in @code{-hook}. You can add hooks with
434 either @code{customize-option} or @code{add-hook}.
438 @cindex Emacs, region
445 There are several other terms that are used in Emacs that you should
446 know. The @dfn{point} is where the cursor currently is. You can save
447 your current place in the file by setting a @dfn{mark}. This operation
448 is useful in several ways. The mark can be later used when defining a
449 @dfn{region}, which is the text between the point and mark. Many
450 commands operate on regions, such as those for deleting text or
451 filling paragraphs. A mark can be set with @kbd{C-@@} (or
455 @cindex Emacs, completion
456 @cindex Emacs, file completion
457 @cindex Emacs, folder completion
458 @cindex Emacs, minibuffer
459 @cindex file completion
460 @cindex folder completion
465 The @dfn{minibuffer} is the bottom line of the Emacs window, where all
466 prompting and multiple-character input is directed. You can use
467 @dfn{completion} to enter values such as folders. Completion means
468 that Emacs fills in text for you when you type @key{SPC} or @key{TAB}.
469 A second @key{SPC} or @key{TAB} will list all possibilities at that
472 @xref{Completion, , Completion, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
476 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Completion.html,
477 Completion} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
479 Note that @key{SPC} cannot be used for completing filenames and
482 @findex help-with-tutorial
486 The minibuffer is also where you enter Emacs function names after
487 typing @kbd{M-x}. For example, in the preface, I mentioned that you
488 could obtain help with @kbd{C-h t} (@code{help-with-tutorial}). What
489 this means is that you can get a tutorial by typing either @kbd{C-h t}
490 or @kbd{M-x help-with-tutorial}. In the latter case, you are prompted
491 for @samp{help-with-tutorial} in the minibuffer after typing
496 The @samp{~} notation in filenames represents your home directory.
497 This notation is used by many shells including @command{bash},
498 @code{tcsh}, and @command{csh}. It is analogous to the environment
499 variable @samp{$HOME}. For example, @file{~/.emacs} can be written
500 @file{$HOME/.emacs} or using the absolute path as in
501 @file{/home/wohler/.emacs} instead.
503 @cindex Emacs, interrupting
504 @cindex Emacs, quitting
508 @i{In case of trouble:} Emacs can be interrupted at any time with
509 @kbd{C-g}. For example, if you've started a command that requests that
510 you enter something in the minibuffer, but then you change your mind,
511 type @kbd{C-g} and you'll be back where you started. If you want to
512 exit Emacs entirely, use @kbd{C-x C-c}.
514 @node Getting Started, Tour Through MH-E, Conventions, Top
515 @chapter Getting Started
517 @cindex MH-E, versions
519 @cindex versions of MH-E
521 Because there are many old versions of MH-E out there, it is important
522 to know which version you have. I'll be talking about @w{Version 8}
523 which is pretty close to @w{Version 6} and @w{Version 7}. It differs
524 from @w{Version 4} and @w{Version 5} and is vastly different from
525 @w{Version 3}. @xref{History}.
529 To determine which version of MH-E that you have, enter @kbd{M-x
530 mh-version @key{RET}}. Hopefully it says that you're running
531 @w{Version @value{VERSION}} which is the latest version as of this
534 If your version is much older than this, please consider upgrading.
535 You can have your system administrator upgrade the system-wide
536 version, or you can install your own personal version. It's really
537 quite easy. @xref{Getting MH-E}, for instructions for getting and
540 If the @code{mh-version} command displays @samp{No MH variant
541 detected}@footnote{In very old versions of MH-E, you may get the error
542 message, @samp{Cannot find the commands `inc' and `mhl' and the file
543 `components'} if MH-E can't find MH. In this case, you need to update
544 MH-E, and you may need to install MH too. However, newer versions of
545 MH-E are better at finding MH if it is on your system.}, then you need
546 to install MH or tell MH-E where to find MH.
550 @cindex GNU mailutils
552 If you don't have MH on your system already, you must install a
553 variant of MH. The Debian mh-e package does this for you automatically
554 (@pxref{Getting MH-E}). Most people use
555 @uref{http://www.nongnu.org/nmh/, nmh}, but you may be interested in
556 trying out @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/mailutils/, GNU
557 mailutils}, which supports IMAP. Your GNU/Linux distribution probably
558 has packages for both of these.
560 @cindex @command{install-mh}
561 @cindex MH commands, @command{install-mh}
564 If you've never run MH before, you need to run @command{install-mh}
565 from the shell before you continue. This sets up your personal MH
566 environment@footnote{See the section
567 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/../overall/setup.html, Setting Up MH} in the
568 MH book.}. If you don't, you'll be greeted with the error message:
569 @samp{Install MH and run install-mh before running MH-E}. This is all
570 you need to know about MH to use MH-E, but the more you know about MH,
571 the more you can leverage its power. See the
572 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/../, MH book} to learn more about MH.
574 @cindex @samp{Path:} MH profile component
576 @cindex MH profile component
577 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Path:}
579 Your MH environment includes your @dfn{MH profile} which is found in
580 the file @file{~/.mh_profile}. This file contains a number of @dfn{MH
581 profile components}. For example, the @samp{Path:} MH profile
582 component contains the path to your mail directory, which is
583 @file{~/Mail} by default.
585 @cindex @command{mhparam}
586 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhparam}
591 @vindex mh-variant-in-use
593 There are several options MH-E uses to interact with your MH
594 installation. The option @code{mh-variant} specifies the variant used
595 by MH-E (@pxref{Options}). The default setting of this option is
596 @samp{Auto-detect} which means that MH-E will automatically choose the
597 first of nmh, MH, or GNU mailutils that it finds in the directories
598 listed in @code{mh-path} (which you can customize),
599 @code{mh-sys-path}, and @code{exec-path}. If MH-E can't find MH at
600 all, you may have to customize @code{mh-path} and add the directory in
601 which the command @command{mhparam} is located. If, on the other hand,
602 you have both nmh and mailutils installed (for example) and
603 @code{mh-variant-in-use} was initialized to nmh but you want to use
604 mailutils, then you can set @code{mh-variant} to @samp{mailutils}.
606 @vindex mh-flists-present-flag
611 When @code{mh-variant} is changed, MH-E resets @code{mh-progs},
612 @code{mh-lib}, @code{mh-lib-progs}, @code{mh-flists-present-flag}, and
613 @code{mh-variant-in-use} accordingly.
615 @cindex @file{.emacs}
616 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
619 @center @strong{NOTE}
622 Prior to version 8, it was often necessary to set some of these
623 variables in @file{~/.emacs}; now it is no longer necessary and can
624 actually cause problems.
628 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Draft-Folder:}
629 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Path:}
630 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Previous-Sequence:}
631 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}
632 @cindex @samp{Draft-Folder:} MH profile component
633 @cindex @samp{Path:} MH profile component
634 @cindex @samp{Previous-Sequence:} MH profile component
635 @cindex @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} MH profile component
637 @vindex mh-draft-folder
638 @vindex mh-find-path-hook
640 @vindex mh-previous-seq
641 @vindex mh-unseen-seq
644 In addition to setting variables that point to MH itself, MH-E also
645 sets a handful of variables that point to where you keep your mail.
646 During initialization, the function @code{mh-find-path} sets
647 @code{mh-user-path} from your @samp{Path:} MH profile component (but
648 defaults to @samp{Mail} if one isn't present), @code{mh-draft-folder}
649 from @samp{Draft-Folder:}, @code{mh-unseen-seq} from
650 @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}, @code{mh-previous-seq} from
651 @samp{Previous-Sequence:}, and @code{mh-inbox} from @samp{Inbox:}
652 (defaults to @samp{+inbox}). The hook @code{mh-find-path-hook} is run
653 after these variables have been set. This hook can be used the change
654 the value of these variables if you need to run with different values
657 @node Tour Through MH-E, Using This Manual, Getting Started, Top
658 @chapter Tour Through MH-E
664 This chapter introduces some of the terms you'll need to know and then
665 takes you on a tour of MH-E@footnote{The keys mentioned in these
666 chapters refer to the default key bindings. If you've changed the
667 bindings, refer to the command summaries at the beginning of each
668 chapter for a mapping between default key bindings and function
669 names.}. When you're done, you'll be able to send, read, and file
670 mail, which is all that a lot of people ever do. But if you're the
671 curious or adventurous type, read the rest of the manual to be able to
672 use all the features of MH-E. I suggest you read this chapter first to
673 get the big picture, and then you can read the manual as you wish.
676 * Sending Mail Tour::
677 * Reading Mail Tour::
678 * Processing Mail Tour::
683 @node Sending Mail Tour, Reading Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E, Tour Through MH-E
684 @section Sending Mail
686 @cindex MH-Letter mode
688 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
693 Let's start our tour by sending ourselves a message which we can later
694 read and process. Enter @kbd{M-x mh-smail} to invoke the MH-E program
695 to send messages. Your message appears in an Emacs buffer whose
696 mode@footnote{A @dfn{mode} changes Emacs to make it easier to edit a
697 particular type of text.} is MH-Letter.
699 Enter your login name in the @samp{To:} header field. Press the
700 @key{TAB} twice to move the cursor past the @samp{Cc:} field, since no
701 carbon copies are to be sent, and on to the @samp{Subject:} field.
702 Enter @kbd{Test} or anything else that comes to mind.
704 Press @key{TAB} again to move the cursor to the body of the message.
705 Enter some text, using normal Emacs commands. You should now have
706 something like this@footnote{If you're running Emacs under the X
707 Window System, then you would also see a menu bar and a tool bar. I've
708 left out the menu bar and tool bar in all of the example screens.}:
718 --:-- *scratch* All L1 (Lisp Interaction)-------------------------
722 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
724 This is a test message to get the wheels churning...#
727 --:** @{draft@} All L5 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
728 Type C-c C-c to send message, C-C ? for help
731 @i{MH-E message composition window}
733 Note the line of dashes that separates the header and the body of the
734 message. It is essential that these dashes (or a blank line) are
735 present or the body of your message will be considered to be part of
739 @findex describe-mode
744 There are several commands specific to MH-Letter mode@footnote{You can
745 get quick help for the commands used most often with @kbd{C-c ?} or
746 more complete help with the @kbd{C-h m} (@code{describe-mode})
747 command.}, but at this time we'll only use @kbd{C-c C-c} to send your
748 message. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} now. That's all there is to it!
750 @node Reading Mail Tour, Processing Mail Tour, Sending Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E
751 @section Receiving Mail
753 @cindex @command{inc}
754 @cindex @command{scan}
755 @cindex MH commands, @command{inc}
756 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
757 @cindex MH-Folder mode
758 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
763 To read the mail you've just sent yourself, enter @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}.
764 This incorporates the new mail and puts the output from
765 @command{inc}@footnote{See the section
766 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
767 prev} in the MH book.} (called @dfn{scan lines} after the MH program
768 @command{scan}@footnote{See the section
769 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/faswsprs.html, Find and Specify with scan
770 pick Ranges Sequences} in the MH book.} which prints a one-line
771 summary of each message) into a buffer called @samp{+inbox} whose
772 major mode is MH-Folder.
779 @center @strong{NOTE}
783 The @kbd{M-x mh-rmail} command will show you only new mail, not mail
784 you have already read. If you were to run this tour again, you would
785 use @kbd{F r} to pull all your messages into MH-E.
793 You should see the scan line for your message, and perhaps others. Use
794 @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to move the cursor to your test message and type
795 @key{RET} to read your message. You should see something like:
799 3 t08/24 root received fax files on Wed Aug 24 11:00:13 PDT 1
800 # 4+t08/24 To:wohler Test<<This is a test message to get the wheels
802 -:%% @{+inbox/select@} 4 msgs (1-4) Bot L4 (MH-Folder Show)---------
805 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
806 Date: Fri, 17 Mar 2006 10:49:11 -0800
807 From: Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
809 This is a test message to get the wheels churning...
813 --:-- @{show-+inbox@} 4 All L1 (MH-Show)----------------------------
817 @i{After incorporating new messages}
822 If you typed a long message, you can view subsequent pages with
823 @key{SPC} and previous pages with @key{DEL}.
825 @node Processing Mail Tour, Leaving MH-E, Reading Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E
826 @section Processing Mail
828 @cindex processing mail
832 The first thing we want to do is reply to the message that we sent
833 ourselves. Ensure that the cursor is still on the same line as your
834 test message and type @kbd{r}. You are prompted in the minibuffer with
835 @samp{Reply to whom:}. Here MH-E is asking whether you'd like to reply
836 to the original sender only, to the sender and primary recipients, or
837 to the sender and all recipients. You can press @key{TAB} to see these
838 choices. If you simply press @key{RET}, you'll reply only to the
839 sender. Press @key{RET} now.
841 You'll find yourself in an Emacs buffer similar to that when you were
842 sending the original message, like this:
849 In-reply-to: <31054.1142621351@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
850 References: <31054.1142621351@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
851 Comments: In-reply-to Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
852 message dated "Fri, 17 Mar 2006 10:49:11 -0800."
853 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
857 --:-- @{draft@} All L10 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
860 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
861 Date: Fri, 17 Mar 2006 10:49:11 -0800
862 From: Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
864 This is a test message to get the wheels churning...
866 --:-- @{show-+inbox@} 4 All L1 (MH-Show)----------------------------
867 Type C-c C-c to send message, C-c ? for help
870 @i{Composition window during reply}
872 @findex backward-char
875 @findex previous-line
884 By default, MH will not add you to the address list of your replies,
885 so if you find that the @samp{To:} header field is missing, don't
886 worry. In this case, type @kbd{C-c C-f C-t} to create and go to the
887 @samp{To:} field, where you can type your login name again. You can
888 move around with the arrow keys or with @kbd{C-p}
889 (@code{previous-line}), @kbd{C-n} (@code{next-line}), @kbd{C-b}
890 (@code{backward-char}), and @kbd{C-f} (@code{forward-char}) and can
891 delete the previous character with @key{BS}. When you're finished
892 editing your message, send it with @kbd{C-c C-c} as before.
894 @cindex @command{refile}
895 @cindex MH commands, @command{refile}
900 You'll often want to save messages that were sent to you in an
901 organized fashion. This is done with @dfn{folders}. You can use
902 folders to keep messages from your friends, or messages related to a
903 particular topic. With your cursor in the MH-Folder buffer and
904 positioned on the message you sent to yourself, type @kbd{o} to output
905 (@command{refile} in MH parlance) that message to a folder. Enter
906 @kbd{test} at the @samp{Destination folder:} prompt and type @kbd{y}
907 (or @key{SPC}) when MH-E asks to create the folder @samp{+test}. Note
908 that a @samp{^} (caret) appears next to the message number, which
909 means that the message has been marked for refiling but has not yet
910 been refiled. We'll talk about how the refile is actually carried out
913 @cindex MH-Folder mode
914 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
922 Your previous reply is now waiting in the system mailbox. You
923 incorporate this mail into your MH-Folder buffer named @samp{+inbox}
924 with the @kbd{i} command. Do this now. After the mail is incorporated,
925 use @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to move the cursor to the new message, and read
926 it with @key{RET}. Let's delete this message by typing @kbd{d}. Note
927 that a @samp{D} appears next to the message number. This means that
928 the message is marked for deletion but is not yet deleted. To perform
929 the deletion (and the refile we did previously), use the @kbd{x}
936 If you want to send another message you can use @kbd{m} instead of
937 @kbd{M-x mh-smail}. So go ahead, send some mail to your friends!
940 @cindex prefix characters
941 @findex describe-mode
946 You can get a quick reminder about these commands by typing @kbd{?}.
947 This lists several @dfn{prefix characters}. To list the commands
948 available via the prefix characters, type the prefix character
949 followed by a @kbd{?}, for example, @kbd{F ?}. More complete help is
950 available with the @kbd{C-h m} (@code{describe-mode}) command.
952 @node Leaving MH-E, More About MH-E, Processing Mail Tour, Tour Through MH-E
953 @section Leaving MH-E
955 @cindex Emacs, quitting
960 You may now wish to exit @command{emacs} entirely. Use @kbd{C-x C-c}
961 to exit @command{emacs}. If you exited without running @kbd{x} in the
962 @samp{+inbox} buffer, Emacs will offer to save it for you. Type
963 @kbd{y} or @key{SPC} to save @samp{+inbox} changes, which means to
964 perform any refiles and deletes that you did there.
972 If you don't want to leave Emacs, you can type @kbd{q} to bury (hide)
973 the MH-E folder or delete it entirely with @kbd{C-x k}. You can then
974 later recall it with @kbd{C-x b} or @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}.
976 @cindex @command{packf}
977 @cindex MH commands, @command{packf}
978 @cindex exporting folders
979 @cindex folders, exporting
980 @cindex mbox-style folder
982 On the other hand, if you no longer want to use MH and MH-E, you can
983 take your mail with you. You can copy all of your mail into a single
984 file, mbox-style, by using the MH command @command{packf}. For
985 example, to create a file called @file{msgbox} with the messages in
986 your @samp{+inbox} folder, use @samp{packf +inbox}. The
987 @command{packf} command will append the messages to the file if it
988 already exists, so you can use @samp{folders -recurse -fast} in a
989 script to copy all of your messages into a single file, or using the
990 @samp{-file} argument, a file for each folder.
992 @node More About MH-E, , Leaving MH-E, Tour Through MH-E
993 @section More About MH-E
995 These are the basic commands to get you going, but there are plenty
996 more. If you think that MH-E is for you, read the rest of the manual
997 to find out how you can:
1001 Print your messages (@pxref{Printing}).
1002 @c -------------------------
1004 Edit messages and include your signature (@pxref{Editing Drafts}).
1005 @c -------------------------
1007 Forward messages (@pxref{Forwarding}).
1008 @c -------------------------
1010 Read digests (@pxref{Digests}).
1011 @c -------------------------
1013 Edit bounced messages (@pxref{Editing Again}).
1014 @c -------------------------
1016 Send multimedia messages (@pxref{Adding Attachments}).
1017 @c -------------------------
1019 Read HTML messages (@pxref{HTML}).
1020 @c -------------------------
1022 Use aliases and identities (see @ref{Aliases}, @pxref{Identities}).
1023 @c -------------------------
1025 Create different views of your mail (see @ref{Threading}, @pxref{Limits}).
1026 @c -------------------------
1028 Deal with junk mail (@pxref{Junk}).
1029 @c -------------------------
1031 Handle signed and encrypted messages (see @ref{Reading PGP},
1032 @pxref{Sending PGP}).
1033 @c -------------------------
1035 Process mail that was sent with @command{shar} or @command{uuencode}
1036 (@pxref{Files and Pipes}).
1037 @c -------------------------
1039 Use sequences conveniently (@pxref{Sequences}).
1040 @c -------------------------
1042 Use the speedbar, tool bar, and menu bar (see @ref{Speedbar}, see @ref{Tool
1043 Bar}, @pxref{Menu Bar}).
1044 @c -------------------------
1046 Show header fields in different fonts (@pxref{Reading Mail}).
1047 @c -------------------------
1049 Find previously refiled messages (@pxref{Searching}).
1050 @c -------------------------
1052 Place messages in a file (@pxref{Files and Pipes}).
1055 Remember that you can also use MH commands when you're not running
1056 MH-E (and when you are!).
1058 @node Using This Manual, Incorporating Mail, Tour Through MH-E, Top
1059 @chapter Using This Manual
1061 This chapter begins the meat of the manual which goes into more detail
1062 about every MH-E command and option.
1065 @cindex Emacs, online help
1068 @findex describe-mode
1077 There are many commands, but don't get intimidated. There are command
1078 summaries at the beginning of each chapter. In case you have or would
1079 like to rebind the keys, the command summaries also list the
1080 associated Emacs Lisp function. Furthermore, even if you're stranded
1081 on a desert island with a laptop and are without your manuals, you can
1082 get a summary of all these commands with GNU Emacs online help: use
1083 @kbd{C-h m} (@code{describe-mode}) for a brief summary of commands,
1084 @kbd{?} (@code{mh-help}) for an even briefer summary@footnote{This
1085 help appears in a buffer called @samp{*MH-E Help*}
1086 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}).} (@kbd{C-c ?} in MH-Letter mode), or @kbd{C-h
1087 i} to read this manual via Info. The online help is quite good; try
1088 running @kbd{C-h C-h}. This brings up a list of available help topics,
1089 one of which displays the documentation for a given key (like @kbd{C-h
1090 k C-n}). Another useful help feature is to view the manual section
1091 that describes a given key (such as @kbd{C-h K i}). In addition,
1092 review @ref{Conventions}, if any of the GNU Emacs conventions are
1095 In addition to all of the commands, it is also possible to reconfigure
1096 MH-E to fit the needs of even the most demanding user. The following
1097 chapters also describe all of the options, show the defaults, and make
1098 recommendations for customization.
1100 However, when customizing your mail environment, first try to change
1101 what you want in MH, and only change MH-E if changing MH is not
1102 possible. That way you will get the same behavior inside and outside
1103 GNU Emacs. Note that MH-E does not provide hooks for customizations
1104 that can be done in MH; this omission is intentional.
1106 @cindex Emacs Lisp Manual
1107 @cindex Emacs, Emacs Lisp Manual
1109 @cindex Emacs, online help
1113 I hope I've included enough examples here to get you well on your way.
1114 If you want to explore Emacs Lisp further, a programming manual does
1116 @c Yes, some of the stuff in the following sections is redundant, but
1117 @c TeX barfs if the @ifs are inside the @footnote.
1119 @footnote{The @cite{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual} may be available
1120 online in the Info system by typing @kbd{C-h i m Emacs Lisp
1121 @key{RET}}. It is also available online at @*
1122 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/elisp-manual/html_node/}. You
1123 can also order a printed manual, which has the desirable side-effect
1124 of helping to support the Free Software Foundation which made all this
1125 great software available. You can find an order form by running
1126 @kbd{C-h C-d}, or you can request an order form from @i{gnu at
1130 @footnote{@xref{Top, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual, , elisp, GNU
1131 Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, which may be available online in the
1132 Info system. It is also available online at
1133 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/elisp-manual/html_node/}. You
1134 can also order a printed manual, which has the desirable side-effect
1135 of helping to support the Free Software Foundation which made all this
1136 great software available. You can find an order form by running
1137 @kbd{C-h C-d}, or you can request an order form from @i{gnu at
1142 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/elisp-manual/html_node/,
1143 The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual} may also be available online in
1144 the Info system by typing @kbd{C-h i m Emacs Lisp @key{RET}}. You can
1145 also order a printed manual, which has the desirable side-effect of
1146 helping to support the Free Software Foundation which made all this
1147 great software available. You can find an order form by running
1148 @kbd{C-h C-d}, or you can request an order form from @i{gnu at
1151 and you can look at the code itself for examples. Look in the Emacs
1152 Lisp directory on your system (such as
1153 @file{/usr/local/lib/emacs/lisp/mh-e}) and find all the @file{mh-*.el}
1154 files there. When calling MH-E and other Emacs Lisp functions directly
1155 from Emacs Lisp code, you'll need to know the correct arguments. Use
1156 the online help for this. For example, try @kbd{C-h f
1157 mh-execute-commands @key{RET}}. If you write your own functions,
1158 please do not prefix your symbols (variables and functions) with
1159 @samp{mh-}. This prefix is reserved for the MH-E package. To avoid
1160 conflicts with existing MH-E symbols, use a prefix like @samp{my-} or
1161 your initials. (Unless, of course, your initials happen to be @emph{mh}!)
1166 * Folder Selection::
1169 @node Options, Ranges, Using This Manual, Using This Manual
1172 @cindex Emacs, customizing
1173 @cindex Emacs, setting options
1174 @cindex customizing MH-E
1175 @cindex setting options
1176 @findex customize-option
1177 @vindex mh-lpr-command-format, example
1179 Many string or integer options are easy to modify using @kbd{M-x
1180 customize-option}. For example, to modify the option that controls
1181 printing, you would run @kbd{M-x customize-option @key{RET}
1182 mh-lpr-command-format @key{RET}}. In the buffer that appears, modify
1183 the string to the right of the variable. For example, you may change
1184 the @command{lpr} command with @samp{nenscript -G -r -2 -i'%s'}. Then
1185 use the @samp{State} combo box and select @samp{Save for Future
1186 Sessions}. To read more about @code{mh-lpr-command-format}, see
1192 @cindex option, turning on and off
1194 @findex customize-option
1195 @vindex mh-bury-show-buffer-flag, example
1197 Options can also hold boolean values. In Emacs Lisp, the boolean
1198 values are @code{nil}, which means false, and @code{t}, which means
1199 true. The @code{customize-option} function makes it easy to change
1200 boolean values; simply click on the toggle button in the customize
1201 buffer to switch between @samp{on} (@code{t}) and @samp{off}
1202 (@code{nil}). For example, try setting @code{mh-bury-show-buffer-flag}
1203 to @samp{off} to keep the MH-Show buffer at the top of the buffer
1204 stack. Use the @samp{State} combo box and choose @samp{Set for Current
1205 Session} to see how the option affects the show buffer. Then choose
1206 the @samp{Erase Customization} menu item to reset the option to the
1207 default, which places the MH-Show buffer at the bottom of the buffer
1210 @vindex mh-mhl-format-file, example
1212 The text usually says to turn on an option by setting it to a
1213 @emph{non-@code{nil}} value, because sometimes values other than
1214 @samp{on} are meaningful. An example of this is the variable
1215 @code{mh-mhl-format-file} (@pxref{Viewing}). Other options, such as
1216 hooks, involve a little more Emacs Lisp programming expertise.
1218 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh}
1219 @cindex @samp{mh} customization group
1220 @findex customize-group
1221 @findex mh-customize
1223 You can browse all of the MH-E options with the @code{customize-group}
1224 function. Try entering @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} mh
1225 @key{RET}} to view the top-level options as well as buttons for all of
1226 the MH-E customization groups. Another way to view the MH-E
1227 customization group is to use @kbd{M-x mh-customize @key{RET}}.
1229 @node Ranges, Folder Selection, Options, Using This Manual
1232 @c Sync with mh-folder-mode docstring.
1234 @cindex message abbreviations
1235 @cindex message ranges
1238 Many commands that operate on individual messages, such as
1239 @code{mh-forward} or @code{mh-refile-msg} take a @code{RANGE}
1240 argument. This argument can be used in several ways.
1242 @kindex C-u, with ranges
1244 If you provide the prefix argument @kbd{C-u} to these commands, then
1245 you will be prompted for the message range. This can be any valid MH
1246 range which can include messages, sequences (@pxref{Sequences}), and
1247 the abbreviations (described in the @command{mh}(1) man page):
1251 Indicates all messages in the range <num1> to <num2>, inclusive. The
1252 range must be nonempty.
1253 @c -------------------------
1257 Up to N messages beginning with (or ending with) message num. Num may
1258 be any of the predefined symbols: first, prev, cur, next or last.
1259 @c -------------------------
1264 The first, previous, next or last messages, if they exist.
1265 @c -------------------------
1267 All of the messages.
1270 For example, a range that shows all of these things is @samp{1 2 3
1271 5-10 last:5 unseen}.
1273 @vindex transient-mark-mode
1275 If the option @code{transient-mark-mode} is turned on and you set a
1276 region in the MH-Folder buffer, then the MH-E command will perform the
1277 operation on all messages in that region.
1279 @cindex @samp{mh-range} customization group
1280 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-range}
1282 The @samp{mh-range} customization group contains a single option which
1283 affects how ranges are interpreted.
1286 @item mh-interpret-number-as-range-flag
1287 On means interpret a number as a range (default: @samp{on}).
1290 @vindex mh-interpret-number-as-range-flag
1292 Since one of the most frequent ranges used is @samp{last:N}, MH-E will
1293 interpret input such as @samp{200} as @samp{last:200} if the
1294 @code{mh-interpret-number-as-range-flag} option is on (which is the
1295 default). If you need to scan just the message 200, then use the range
1296 @samp{200:1} or @samp{200-200}.
1298 @node Folder Selection, , Ranges, Using This Manual
1299 @section Folder Selection
1301 @cindex completion, folders
1302 @cindex folders, completion
1303 @cindex folders, selecting
1305 When you choose a folder in MH-E via a command such as @kbd{o}
1306 (@code{mh-refile-msg}), completion is used to enter the folder
1308 (@pxref{Completion, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1312 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Completion.html,
1313 Completion} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1315 In addition, MH-E has several ways of choosing a suitable default so
1316 that the folder can often be selected with a single @key{RET} key.
1318 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-folder-selection}
1319 @cindex @samp{mh-folder-selection} customization group
1321 The @samp{mh-folder-selection} customization group contains some
1322 options which are used to help with this.
1325 @item mh-default-folder-for-message-function
1326 Function to select a default folder for refiling or @samp{Fcc:}
1327 (default: @code{nil}).
1328 @c -------------------------
1329 @item mh-default-folder-list
1330 List of addresses and folders (default: @code{nil}).
1331 @c -------------------------
1332 @item mh-default-folder-must-exist-flag
1333 On means guessed folder name must exist to be used (default:
1335 @c -------------------------
1336 @item mh-default-folder-prefix
1337 Prefix used for folder names generated from aliases (default: @code{""}).
1340 @vindex mh-default-folder-for-message-function
1342 You can set the option @code{mh-default-folder-for-message-function}
1343 to a function that provides a default folder for the message to be
1344 refiled. When this function is called, the current buffer contains the
1345 message being refiled and point is at the start of the message. This
1346 function should return the default folder as a string with a leading
1347 @samp{+} sign. It can also return @code{nil} so that the last folder
1348 name is used as the default, or an empty string to suppress the
1351 Otherwise, the name of the destination folder is derived from the
1355 @vindex mh-default-folder-list
1357 The folder name associated with the first address found in the list
1358 @code{mh-default-folder-list} is used. Each element in this list
1359 contains a @samp{Check Recipient} item. If this item is turned on,
1360 then the address is checked against the recipient instead of the
1361 sender. This is useful for mailing lists.
1362 @c -------------------------
1363 @vindex mh-default-folder-prefix
1365 An alias prefixed by @code{mh-default-folder-prefix} corresponding to
1366 the address is used. The prefix is used to prevent clutter in your
1367 mail directory. @xref{Aliases}.
1370 @vindex mh-default-folder-must-exist-flag
1372 If the derived folder does not exist, and
1373 @code{mh-default-folder-must-exist-flag} is @code{t}, then the last
1374 folder name used is suggested. This is useful if you get mail from
1375 various people for whom you have an alias, but file them all in the
1376 same project folder.
1378 @node Incorporating Mail, Reading Mail, Using This Manual, Top
1379 @chapter Incorporating Your Mail
1381 @cindex @samp{Folder} menu
1382 @cindex incorporating
1383 @cindex menu, @samp{Folder}
1385 This chapter talks about getting mail from your system mailbox into
1386 your MH @samp{+inbox} folder. The following command accomplishes that
1387 and is found in the @samp{Folder} menu.
1390 @cindex @samp{Folder > Incorporate New Mail} menu item
1391 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Incorporate New Mail}
1392 @findex mh-inc-folder
1395 Incorporate new mail into a folder (@code{mh-inc-folder}).
1398 @cindex @samp{mh-inc} customization group
1399 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-inc}
1401 The following options in the @samp{mh-inc} customization group are
1406 Program to incorporate mail (default: @code{"inc"}).
1407 @c -------------------------
1408 @item mh-inc-spool-list
1409 Alternate spool files (default: @code{nil}).
1412 The following hook is available.
1415 @findex mh-inc-folder
1416 @item mh-inc-folder-hook
1417 Hook run by @code{mh-inc-folder} after incorporating mail into a
1418 folder (default: @code{nil}).
1421 @cindex @samp{+inbox}
1422 @findex mh-inc-folder
1425 If at any time you receive new mail, incorporate the new mail into
1426 your @samp{+inbox} buffer with @kbd{i} (@code{mh-inc-folder}). Note
1427 that @kbd{i} will display the @samp{+inbox} buffer, even if there
1428 isn't any new mail. You can incorporate mail from any file into the
1429 current folder by specifying a prefix argument; you'll be prompted for
1430 the name of the file to use as well as the destination folder (for
1431 example, @kbd{C-u i ~/mbox @key{RET} +tmp @key{RET}}).
1433 @cindex @file{.emacs}
1434 @cindex Emacs, notification of new mail
1435 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
1437 @cindex notification of new mail
1439 Emacs can notify you when you have new mail by displaying @samp{Mail}
1440 in the mode line. To enable this behavior, and to have a clock in the
1441 mode line as well, add the following to @file{~/.emacs}:
1443 @findex display-time
1449 @cindex @command{inc}
1450 @cindex incorporating
1451 @cindex MH commands, @command{inc}
1455 The name of the program that incorporates new mail is stored in
1456 @code{mh-inc-prog}; it is @code{"inc"} by default. This program
1457 generates a one-line summary for each of the new messages. Unless it
1458 is an absolute pathname, the file is assumed to be in the
1459 @code{mh-progs} directory (@pxref{Getting Started}). You may also link
1460 a file to @command{inc} that uses a different format (see
1461 @samp{mh-profile}(5), and sections
1462 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
1463 prev} and @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/mhstr.html, MH Format Strings} in
1464 the MH book). You'll then need to modify several variables
1465 appropriately (@pxref{Scan Line Formats}).
1467 @vindex mh-inc-spool-list
1469 You can use the @code{mh-inc-spool-list} variable to direct MH-E to
1470 retrieve mail from arbitrary spool files other than your system
1471 mailbox, file it in folders other than your @samp{+inbox}, and assign
1472 key bindings to incorporate this mail.
1474 @cindex @command{procmail}
1475 @cindex @file{.procmailrc}
1476 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
1477 @cindex files, @file{.procmailrc}
1479 Suppose you are subscribed to the @i{mh-e-devel} mailing list and you
1480 use @command{procmail} to filter this mail into @file{~/mail/mh-e}
1481 with the following recipe in @file{.procmailrc}:
1484 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
1485 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
1487 * ^From mh-e-devel-admin@@stop.mail-abuse.org
1491 @findex mh-inc-spool-*
1494 In order to incorporate @file{~/mail/mh-e} into @samp{+mh-e} with an
1495 @kbd{I m} (@code{mh-inc-spool-mh-e}) command, customize this option,
1496 and click on the @samp{INS} button. Enter a @samp{Spool File} of
1497 @samp{~/mail/mh-e}, a @samp{Folder} of @samp{mh-e}, and a @samp{Key
1498 Binding} of @samp{m}.
1500 @cindex @command{emacsclient}
1501 @cindex @command{gnuclient}
1502 @cindex @command{xbuffy}
1503 @cindex @samp{gnuserv}
1504 @cindex Unix commands, @command{emacsclient}
1505 @cindex Unix commands, @command{gnuclient}
1506 @cindex Unix commands, @command{xbuffy}
1508 You can use @command{xbuffy} to automate the incorporation of this
1509 mail using the Emacs 22 command @command{emacsclient} as follows:
1517 command emacsclient --eval '(mh-inc-spool-mh-e)'
1520 In XEmacs, the command @command{gnuclient} is used in a similar
1523 @findex mh-inc-folder
1525 @vindex mh-inc-folder-hook
1527 You can set the hook @code{mh-inc-folder-hook}, which is called after
1528 new mail is incorporated by the @kbd{i} (@code{mh-inc-folder})
1529 command. A good use of this hook is to rescan the whole folder either
1530 after running @kbd{M-x mh-rmail} the first time or when you've changed
1531 the message numbers from outside of MH-E.
1533 @findex mh-execute-commands
1534 @findex mh-rescan-folder, example
1535 @findex mh-show, example
1536 @vindex mh-inc-folder-hook, example
1540 (defun my-mh-inc-folder-hook ()
1541 "Hook to rescan folder after incorporating mail."
1542 (if (buffer-modified-p) ; @r{if outstanding refiles and deletes,}
1543 (mh-execute-commands)) ; @r{carry them out}
1544 (mh-rescan-folder) ; @r{synchronize with +inbox}
1545 (mh-show)) ; @r{show the current message}
1547 (add-hook 'mh-inc-folder-hook 'my-mh-inc-folder-hook)
1549 @i{Rescan folder after incorporating new mail via mh-inc-folder-hook}
1554 @node Reading Mail, Folders, Incorporating Mail, Top
1555 @chapter Reading Your Mail
1557 @cindex @samp{+inbox}
1558 @cindex MH-Folder mode
1559 @cindex MH-Show mode
1560 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
1561 @cindex modes, MH-Show
1562 @cindex reading mail
1566 @kindex M-x mh-rmail
1568 The MH-E entry point for reading mail is @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}. This
1569 command incorporates your mail and creates a buffer called
1570 @samp{+inbox} in MH-Folder mode. The command @kbd{M-x mh-rmail} shows
1571 you only new mail, not mail you have already read@footnote{If you want
1572 to see your old mail as well, use @kbd{F r} to pull all your messages
1573 into MH-E. Or, give a prefix argument to @code{mh-rmail} so it will
1574 prompt you for folder to visit like @kbd{F v} (for example, @kbd{C-u
1575 M-x mh-rmail @key{RET} bob @key{RET}}). @xref{Folders}.}.
1577 @findex display-time
1578 @vindex read-mail-command
1580 There are some commands that need to read mail, such as @kbd{Mouse-2}
1581 over the @samp{Mail} button that @code{display-time} adds to the mode
1582 line. You can configure Emacs to have these commands use MH-E by
1583 setting the option @code{read-mail-command} to @samp{mh-rmail}.
1585 @cindex @command{scan}
1586 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
1587 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
1588 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
1591 The @samp{+inbox} buffer contains @dfn{scan lines}, which are one-line
1592 summaries of each incorporated message. You can perform most MH
1593 commands on these messages via one- or two-letter commands in either
1594 the MH-Folder or MH-Show buffers or by using the @samp{Message} menu.
1595 See @command{scan}(1) for a description of the contents of the scan
1596 lines, and see the Figure in @ref{Reading Mail Tour}, for an example.
1602 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
1603 @c -------------------------
1604 @cindex @samp{Message > Show Message} menu item
1605 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Show Message}
1609 Display message (@code{mh-show}).
1610 @c -------------------------
1611 @cindex @samp{Message > Show Message with Header} menu item
1612 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Show Message with Header}
1614 @findex mh-header-display
1616 Display message with all header fields (@code{mh-header-display}).
1617 @c -------------------------
1618 @kindex ; (semicolon)
1619 @findex mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag
1621 Toggle the value of @code{mh-decode-mime-flag}
1622 (@code{mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag}).
1623 @c -------------------------
1627 Display next page in message (@code{mh-page-msg}).
1628 @c -------------------------
1630 @findex mh-previous-page
1632 Display previous page in message (@code{mh-previous-page}).
1633 @c -------------------------
1634 @cindex @samp{Message > Write Message to File...} menu item
1635 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Write Message to File...}
1637 @findex mh-write-msg-to-file
1639 Append message to end of file (@code{mh-write-msg-to-file}).
1640 @c -------------------------
1641 @cindex @samp{Message > Pipe Message to Command...} menu item
1642 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Pipe Message to Command...}
1646 Pipe message through shell command (@code{mh-pipe-msg}).
1647 @c -------------------------
1649 @findex mh-delete-msg-no-motion
1651 Delete range, don't move to next message
1652 (@code{mh-delete-msg-no-motion}).
1653 @c -------------------------
1654 @cindex @samp{Message > Delete Message} menu item
1655 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Delete Message}
1657 @findex mh-delete-msg
1659 Delete range (@code{mh-delete-msg}).
1660 @c -------------------------
1662 @findex mh-prefix-help
1664 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1665 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1666 @c -------------------------
1668 @findex mh-page-digest
1670 Display next message in digest (@code{mh-page-digest}).
1671 @c -------------------------
1673 @findex mh-page-digest-backwards
1675 Display previous message in digest (@code{mh-page-digest-backwards}).
1676 @c -------------------------
1677 @cindex @samp{Message > Burst Digest Message} menu item
1678 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Burst Digest Message}
1680 @findex mh-burst-digest
1682 Break up digest into separate messages (@code{mh-burst-digest}).
1683 @c -------------------------
1684 @cindex @samp{Message > Go to Message by Number...} menu item
1685 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Go to Message by Number...}
1689 Go to a message (@code{mh-goto-msg}).
1690 @c -------------------------
1692 @findex mh-delete-subject-or-thread
1694 Delete messages with same subject or thread
1695 (@code{mh-delete-subject-or-thread}).
1696 @c -------------------------
1698 @findex mh-prefix-help
1700 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1701 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1702 @c -------------------------
1704 @findex mh-next-button
1706 Go to the next button (@code{mh-next-button}).
1707 @c -------------------------
1708 @kindex K S-@key{TAB}
1709 @findex mh-prev-button
1711 Go to the previous button (@code{mh-prev-button}).
1712 @c -------------------------
1714 @findex mh-mime-save-parts
1716 Save attachments (@code{mh-mime-save-parts}).
1717 @c -------------------------
1719 @findex mh-display-with-external-viewer
1721 View attachment externally (@code{mh-display-with-external-viewer}).
1722 @c -------------------------
1724 @findex mh-folder-inline-mime-part
1726 Show attachment verbatim (@code{mh-folder-inline-mime-part}).
1727 @c -------------------------
1729 @findex mh-folder-save-mime-part
1731 Save (output) attachment (@code{mh-folder-save-mime-part}).
1732 @c -------------------------
1734 @findex mh-toggle-mime-buttons
1736 Toggle option @code{mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag}
1737 (@code{mh-toggle-mime-buttons}).
1738 @c -------------------------
1740 @findex mh-folder-toggle-mime-part
1742 View attachment (@code{mh-folder-toggle-mime-part}).
1743 @c -------------------------
1744 @cindex @samp{Message > Modify Message} menu item
1745 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Modify Message}
1749 Edit message (@code{mh-modify}).
1750 @c -------------------------
1751 @cindex @samp{Message > Go to First Message} menu item
1752 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Go to First Message}
1754 @findex mh-first-msg
1756 Display first message (@code{mh-first-msg}).
1757 @c -------------------------
1758 @cindex @samp{Message > Go to Last Message} menu item
1759 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Go to Last Message}
1763 Display last message (@code{mh-last-msg}).
1764 @c -------------------------
1766 @findex mh-next-unread-msg
1768 Display next unread message (@code{mh-next-unread-msg}).
1769 @c -------------------------
1771 @findex mh-previous-unread-msg
1773 Display previous unread message (@code{mh-previous-unread-msg}).
1774 @c -------------------------
1775 @cindex @samp{Message > Next Message} menu item
1776 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Next Message}
1778 @findex mh-next-undeleted-msg
1780 Display next message (@code{mh-next-undeleted-msg}).
1781 @c -------------------------
1782 @cindex @samp{Message > Previous Message} menu item
1783 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Previous Message}
1785 @findex mh-previous-undeleted-msg
1787 Display previous message (@code{mh-previous-undeleted-msg}).
1788 @c -------------------------
1790 @findex mh-prefix-help
1792 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1793 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1794 @c -------------------------
1796 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-color
1798 Toggle whether color is used in printing messages
1799 (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-color}).
1800 @c -------------------------
1802 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-faces
1804 Toggle whether printing is done with faces or not
1805 (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-faces}).
1806 @c -------------------------
1808 @findex mh-ps-print-msg-file
1810 Print range to file (@code{mh-ps-print-msg-file}).
1811 @c -------------------------
1812 @cindex @samp{Message > Print Message} menu item
1813 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Print Message}
1815 @findex mh-print-msg
1817 Print range the old fashioned way
1818 (@code{mh-print-msg}).
1819 @c -------------------------
1821 @findex mh-ps-print-msg
1823 Print range (@code{mh-ps-print-msg}).
1824 @c -------------------------
1826 @findex mh-prefix-help
1828 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
1829 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
1830 @c -------------------------
1831 @cindex @samp{Message > Unpack Uuencoded Message...} menu item
1832 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Unpack Uuencoded Message...}
1835 @findex mh-store-msg
1838 Unpack message created with @command{uudecode} or @command{shar}
1839 (@code{mh-store-msg}).
1840 @c -------------------------
1842 @findex mh-show-mouse
1844 Move point to mouse event and show message (@code{mh-show-mouse}).
1847 Within the MH-Show buffer, the following command is defined.
1853 @findex mh-press-button
1857 View contents of button (@code{mh-press-button}).
1860 @cindex @samp{mh-show} customization group
1861 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-show}
1863 The following table lists options in the @samp{mh-show} customization
1864 group that are used while reading mail.
1867 @item mh-bury-show-buffer-flag
1868 On means show buffer is buried (default: @samp{on}).
1869 @c -------------------------
1870 @item mh-clean-message-header-flag
1871 On means remove extraneous header fields (default: @samp{on}).
1872 @c -------------------------
1873 @item mh-decode-mime-flag
1874 On means attachments are handled (default: @samp{on} if the Gnus
1875 @samp{mm-decode} package is present).
1876 @c -------------------------
1877 @item mh-display-buttons-for-alternatives-flag
1878 On means display buttons for all alternative attachments (default:
1880 @c -------------------------
1881 @item mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag
1882 On means display buttons for all inline attachments (default:
1884 @c -------------------------
1885 @item mh-do-not-confirm-flag
1886 On means non-reversible commands do not prompt for confirmation
1887 (default: @samp{off}).
1888 @c -------------------------
1889 @item mh-fetch-x-image-url
1890 Control fetching of @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field image (default:
1891 @samp{Never Fetch}).
1892 @c -------------------------
1893 @item mh-graphical-smileys-flag
1894 On means graphical smileys are displayed (default: @samp{on}).
1895 @c -------------------------
1896 @item mh-graphical-emphasis-flag
1897 On means graphical emphasis is displayed (default: @samp{on}).
1898 @c -------------------------
1899 @item mh-highlight-citation-style
1900 Style for highlighting citations (default: @samp{Multicolor}).
1901 @c -------------------------
1902 @item mh-invisible-header-fields-default
1903 List of hidden header fields (default: a checklist too long to list
1905 @c -------------------------
1906 @item mh-invisible-header-fields
1907 Additional header fields to hide (default: @code{nil}).
1908 @c -------------------------
1909 @item mh-lpr-command-format
1910 Command used to print (default: @code{"lpr -J '%s'"}).
1911 @c -------------------------
1912 @item mh-max-inline-image-height
1913 Maximum inline image height if @samp{Content-Disposition:} is not
1914 present (default: 0).
1915 @c -------------------------
1916 @item mh-max-inline-image-width
1917 Maximum inline image width if @samp{Content-Disposition:} is not
1918 present(default: 0).
1919 @c -------------------------
1920 @item mh-mhl-format-file
1921 Specifies the format file to pass to the @command{mhl} program
1922 (default: @samp{Use Default mhl Format (Printing Only)}).
1923 @c -------------------------
1924 @item mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory
1925 Default directory to use for @kbd{K a}.
1926 @c -------------------------
1927 @item mh-print-background-flag
1928 On means messages should be printed in the background (default:
1930 @c -------------------------
1931 @item mh-show-buffer-mode-line-buffer-id
1932 Format string to produce @code{mode-line-buffer-identification} for
1933 show buffers (default: @code{" @{show-%s@} %d"}).
1934 @c -------------------------
1935 @item mh-show-maximum-size
1936 Maximum size of message (in bytes) to display automatically (default:
1938 @c -------------------------
1939 @item mh-show-use-xface-flag
1940 On means display face images in MH-Show buffers (default: @samp{on}).
1941 @c -------------------------
1942 @item mh-store-default-directory
1943 Default directory for @kbd{X s} (default: @samp{Current}).
1944 @c -------------------------
1945 @item mh-summary-height
1946 Number of lines in MH-Folder buffer (including the mode line)
1947 (default: depends on size of frame).
1950 The following hooks are available.
1953 @item mh-delete-msg-hook
1954 Hook run after marking each message for deletion (default: @code{nil}).
1955 @c -------------------------
1957 Hook run after @key{RET} shows a message (default: @code{nil}).
1958 @c -------------------------
1959 @item mh-show-mode-hook
1960 Hook run upon entry to @code{mh-show-mode} (default: @code{nil}).
1963 The following faces are available.
1967 Face used to highlight @samp{cc:} header fields.
1968 @c -------------------------
1970 Face used to highlight @samp{Date:} header fields.
1971 @c -------------------------
1973 Face used to highlight @samp{From:} header fields.
1974 @c -------------------------
1975 @item mh-show-header
1976 Face used to deemphasize less interesting header fields.
1977 @c -------------------------
1978 @item mh-show-pgg-bad
1979 Bad PGG signature face.
1980 @c -------------------------
1981 @item mh-show-pgg-good
1982 Good PGG signature face.
1983 @c -------------------------
1984 @item mh-show-pgg-unknown
1985 Unknown or untrusted PGG signature face.
1986 @c -------------------------
1987 @item mh-show-signature
1989 @c -------------------------
1990 @item mh-show-subject
1991 Face used to highlight @samp{Subject:} header fields.
1992 @c -------------------------
1994 Face used to highlight @samp{To:} header fields.
1995 @c -------------------------
2000 The functions and variables introduced here are explained in more
2001 detail in the following sections.
2005 * Viewing Attachments::
2012 * Miscellaneous Commands and Options::
2015 @node Viewing, Viewing Attachments, Reading Mail, Reading Mail
2016 @section Viewing Your Mail
2018 @findex mh-header-display
2020 @findex mh-previous-page
2022 @findex mh-show-mouse
2030 The command @key{RET} (@code{mh-show}) displays the message that the
2031 cursor is on while @kbd{Mouse-2} (@code{mh-show-mouse}) displays the
2032 message that the mouse cursor is on. If the message is already
2033 displayed, it scrolls to the beginning of the message. Use @key{SPC}
2034 (@code{mh-page-msg}) and @key{BS} (@code{mh-previous-page}) to move
2035 forwards and backwards one page at a time through the message. You can
2036 give either of these commands a prefix argument that specifies the
2037 number of lines to scroll (such as @kbd{10 @key{SPC}}). The @key{SPC}
2038 command will also show the next undeleted message if it is used at the
2039 bottom of a message. MH-E normally hides a lot of the superfluous
2040 header fields that mailers add to a message, but if you wish to see
2041 all of them, use the command @kbd{,} (comma;
2042 @code{mh-header-display}).
2044 @vindex mh-show-maximum-size
2046 The option @code{mh-show-maximum-size} provides an opportunity to skip
2047 over large messages which may be slow to load. The default value of 0
2048 means that all message are shown regardless of size.
2050 A litany of options control what displayed messages look like.
2053 @vindex mh-show-date
2054 @vindex mh-show-from
2055 @vindex mh-show-header
2056 @vindex mh-show-subject
2059 First, the appearance of the header fields can be modified by
2060 customizing the associated face: @code{mh-show-to}, @code{mh-show-cc},
2061 @code{mh-show-from}, @code{mh-show-date}, and @code{mh-show-subject}.
2062 The face @code{mh-show-header} is used to deemphasize the other, less
2063 interesting, header fields.
2065 @cindex regular expressions, @code{mh-invisible-header-fields}
2066 @vindex mh-clean-message-header-flag
2067 @vindex mh-invisible-header-fields
2068 @vindex mh-invisible-header-fields-default
2070 Normally messages are delivered with a handful of uninteresting header
2071 fields. These are hidden by turning on the option
2072 @code{mh-clean-message-header-flag} (which it is by default). The
2073 header fields listed in the option
2074 @code{mh-invisible-header-fields-default} are hidden, although you can
2075 check off any field that you would like to see. Header fields that you
2076 would like to hide that aren't listed can be added to the option
2077 @code{mh-invisible-header-fields} with a couple of caveats. Regular
2078 expressions are not allowed. Unique fields should have a @samp{:}
2079 suffix; otherwise, the element can be used to render invisible an
2080 entire class of fields that start with the same prefix. If you think a
2081 header field should be generally ignored, report a bug (@pxref{Bug
2084 @cindex header field, @samp{Face:}
2085 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Face:}
2086 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Image-URL:}
2087 @cindex @samp{Face:} header field
2088 @cindex @samp{X-Face:} header field
2089 @cindex @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field
2090 @vindex mh-show-use-xface-flag
2092 MH-E can display the content of @samp{Face:}, @samp{X-Face:}, and
2093 @samp{X-Image-URL:} header fields. If any of these fields occur in the
2094 header of your message, the sender's face will appear in the
2095 @samp{From:} header field. If more than one of these fields appear,
2096 then the first field found in the order @samp{Face:}, @samp{X-Face:},
2097 and @samp{X-Image-URL:} will be used. The option
2098 @code{mh-show-use-xface-flag} is used to turn this feature on and off.
2099 This feature will be turned on by default if your system supports it.
2101 The first header field used, if present, is the Gnus-specific
2102 @samp{Face:} field@footnote{The @samp{Face:} field appeared in GNU
2103 Emacs 21 and XEmacs. For more information, see
2104 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/}.}.
2106 @cindex @command{uncompface}
2107 @cindex Emacs, packages, x-face
2108 @cindex Unix commands, @command{uncompface}
2109 @cindex x-face package
2110 @vindex mh-show-xface
2112 Next is the traditional @samp{X-Face:} header field@footnote{The
2113 display of this field requires the
2114 @uref{ftp://ftp.cs.indiana.edu/pub/faces/compface/compface.tar.Z,
2115 @command{uncompface} program}. Recent versions of XEmacs have internal
2116 support for @samp{X-Face:} images. If your version of XEmacs does not,
2117 then you'll need both @command{uncompface} and the
2118 @uref{ftp://ftp.jpl.org/pub/elisp/, @samp{x-face} package}.}. MH-E
2119 renders the foreground and background of the image using the
2120 associated attributes of the face @code{mh-show-xface}.
2122 @cindex @command{convert}
2123 @cindex @command{wget}
2125 @cindex Unix commands, @command{convert}
2126 @cindex Unix commands, @command{wget}
2127 @vindex mh-fetch-x-image-url
2129 Finally, MH-E will display images referenced by the
2130 @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field if neither the @samp{Face:} nor the
2131 @samp{X-Face:} fields are present@footnote{The display of the images
2132 requires the @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/wget/wget.html,
2133 @command{wget} program} to fetch the image and the @command{convert}
2134 program from the @uref{http://www.imagemagick.org/, ImageMagick
2135 suite}.}. Of the three header fields this is the most efficient in
2136 terms of network usage since the image doesn't need to be transmitted
2137 with every single mail. The option @code{mh-fetch-x-image-url}
2138 controls the fetching of the @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field image
2139 with the following values:
2142 @item Ask Before Fetching
2143 You are prompted before the image is fetched. MH-E will remember your
2144 reply and will either use the already fetched image the next time the
2145 same URL is encountered or silently skip it if you didn't fetch it the
2146 first time. This is a good setting.
2147 @c -------------------------
2149 Images are never fetched and only displayed if they are already
2150 present in the cache. This is the default.
2153 There isn't a value of @samp{Always Fetch} for privacy and DOS (denial
2154 of service) reasons. For example, fetching a URL can tip off a spammer
2155 that you've read his email (which is why you shouldn't blindly answer
2156 yes if you've set this option to @samp{Ask Before Fetching}). Someone
2157 may also flood your network and fill your disk drive by sending a
2158 torrent of messages, each specifying a unique URL to a very large
2161 @cindex @file{.mhe-x-image-cache}
2162 @cindex files, @file{.mhe-x-image-cache}
2164 The cache of images is found in the directory
2165 @file{.mhe-x-image-cache} within your MH directory. You can add your
2166 own face to the @samp{From:} field too. @xref{Picture}.
2168 @cindex @command{mhl}
2169 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhl}
2170 @vindex mh-mhl-format-file
2172 Normally MH-E takes care of displaying messages itself (rather than
2173 calling an MH program to do the work). If you'd rather have
2174 @command{mhl} display the message (within MH-E), change the option
2175 @code{mh-mhl-format-file} from its default value of @samp{Use Default
2176 mhl Format (Printing Only)}. You can set this option to @samp{Use
2177 Default mhl Format} to get the same output as you would get if you ran
2178 @command{mhl} from the shell. If you have a format file that you want
2179 MH-E to use, you can set this option to @samp{Specify an mhl Format
2180 File} and enter the name of your format file (@command{mhl}(1) or
2181 section @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/shomes.html#Usisho, Using mhl} in
2182 the MH book tells you how to write one). Your format file should
2183 specify a non-zero value for @samp{overflowoffset} to allow MH-E to
2184 parse the header. Note that @command{mhl} is always used for printing
2185 and forwarding; in this case, the value of @code{mh-mhl-format-file}
2186 is consulted if you have specified a format file.
2188 @cindex citations, highlighting
2189 @cindex highlighting citations
2190 @vindex mh-highlight-citation-style
2192 If the sender of the message has cited other messages in his message,
2193 then MH-E will highlight these citations to emphasize the sender's
2194 actual response. The option @code{mh-highlight-citation-style} can be
2195 customized to change the highlighting style. The @samp{Multicolor}
2196 method uses a different color for each indentation while the
2197 @samp{Monotone} method highlights all citations in red. To disable
2198 highlighting of citations entirely, choose @samp{None}.
2200 @cindex URLs, highlighting
2201 @cindex email addresses, highlighting
2202 @cindex highlighting URLs
2203 @cindex highlighting email addresses
2204 @cindex links, following
2205 @findex goto-address-at-point
2206 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
2208 @vindex goto-address-highlight-p
2210 Email addresses and URLs in the message are highlighted if the option
2211 @code{goto-address-highlight-p} is on, which it is by default. To view
2212 the web page for a highlighted URL or to send a message using a
2213 highlighted email address, use @kbd{Mouse-2} or @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}
2214 (@code{goto-address-at-point}). @xref{Sending Mail}, to see how to
2215 configure Emacs to send the message using MH-E.
2217 @cindex boldface, showing
2219 @cindex italics, showing
2222 @cindex underline, showing
2223 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
2224 @vindex mh-decode-mime-flag
2225 @vindex mh-graphical-emphasis-flag
2226 @vindex mh-graphical-smileys-flag
2228 It is a long standing custom to inject body language using a
2229 cornucopia of punctuation, also known as the @dfn{smileys}. MH-E can
2230 render these as graphical widgets if the option
2231 @code{mh-graphical-smileys-flag} is turned on, which it is by default.
2232 Smileys include patterns such as :-) and ;-). Similarly, a few
2233 typesetting features are indicated in ASCII text with certain
2234 characters. If your terminal supports it, MH-E can render these
2235 typesetting directives naturally if the option
2236 @code{mh-graphical-emphasis-flag} is turned on, which it is by
2237 default. For example, _underline_ will be
2246 *bold* will appear in @b{bold}, /italics/ will appear in @i{italics},
2247 and so on. See the option @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} for the whole
2248 list. Both of these options are disabled if the option
2249 @code{mh-decode-mime-flag} is turned off. @xref{Viewing Attachments}.
2251 @cindex signature separator
2253 @vindex mh-show-signature
2255 MH-E normally renders signatures and vCards in italics so that the
2256 body of the message stands out more. MH-E depends on the presence of
2257 the @dfn{signature separator} (@code{"-- "}) to do this. You can also
2258 customize the face @code{mh-show-signature} so the appearance of the
2259 signature block is more to your liking.
2261 @vindex mh-show-hook
2262 @vindex mh-show-mode-hook
2264 Two hooks can be used to control how messages are displayed. The first
2265 hook, @code{mh-show-mode-hook}, is called early on in the process of
2266 the message display. It is usually used to perform some action on the
2267 message's content. The second hook, @code{mh-show-hook}, is the last
2268 thing called after messages are displayed. It's used to affect the
2269 behavior of MH-E in general or when @code{mh-show-mode-hook} is too
2272 @cindex MH-Show mode
2273 @cindex modes, MH-Show
2274 @vindex mh-show-buffer-mode-line-buffer-id
2276 For those who like to modify their mode lines, use
2277 @code{mh-show-buffer-mode-line-buffer-id} to modify the mode line in
2278 the MH-Show buffers. Place the two escape strings @samp{%s} and
2279 @samp{%d}, which will display the folder name and the message number,
2280 respectively, somewhere in the string in that order. The default value
2281 of @code{"@{show-%s@} %d"} yields a mode line of
2284 -----@{show-+inbox@} 4 (MH-Show)--Bot--------------------------------
2287 @node Viewing Attachments, HTML, Viewing, Reading Mail
2288 @section Viewing Attachments
2292 @cindex @command{mhshow}
2293 @cindex @command{show}
2294 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhshow}
2295 @cindex MH commands, @command{show}
2297 @cindex multimedia mail
2299 MH has the ability to display @dfn{@sc{mime}} (Multipurpose Internet
2300 Mail Extensions) messages which are simply messages with additional
2301 @dfn{body parts} or @dfn{attachments}. You can use the MH commands
2302 @command{show}@footnote{See the section
2303 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
2304 prev} in the MH book.} or @command{mhshow}@footnote{See the section
2305 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/usimim.html#ReMIMa, Reading MIME Mail} in
2306 the MH book.} from the shell to read @sc{mime} messages@footnote{You
2307 can call them directly from Emacs if you're running the X Window
2308 System: type @kbd{M-! xterm -e mhshow @var{message-number}}. You can
2309 leave out the @samp{xterm -e} if you use @command{mhlist} or
2310 @command{mhstore}.}.
2312 @cindex Emacs, packages, mm-decode
2313 @cindex mm-decode package
2314 @findex mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag
2315 @kindex ; (semicolon)
2316 @vindex mh-decode-mime-flag
2318 MH-E can handle attachments as well if the Gnus @samp{mm-decode}
2319 package is present. If so, the option @code{mh-decode-mime-flag} will
2320 be on. Otherwise, you'll see the @sc{mime} body parts rather than text
2321 or attachments. There isn't much point in turning off the option
2322 @code{mh-decode-mime-flag}; however, you can inspect it if it appears
2323 that the body parts are not being interpreted correctly or toggle it
2324 with the command @kbd{;} (semicolon;
2325 @code{mh-toggle-mh-decode-mime-flag}) to view the raw message. This
2326 option also controls the display of quoted-printable messages and
2327 other graphical widgets. @xref{Viewing}.
2331 Attachments in MH-E are indicated by @dfn{buttons} like this:
2334 [1. image/jpeg; foo.jpg]...
2337 @findex mh-next-button
2338 @findex mh-press-button
2339 @findex mh-prev-button
2342 @kindex K S-@key{TAB}
2346 To view the contents of the button, use either @kbd{Mouse-1} or
2347 @kbd{Mouse-2} on the button or @key{RET} (@code{mh-press-button}) when
2348 the cursor is over the button. This command is a toggle so if you use
2349 it again on the same attachment, it is hidden. If Emacs does not know
2350 how to display the attachment, then Emacs offers to save the
2351 attachment in a file. To move the cursor to the next button, use the
2352 command @kbd{K @key{TAB}} (@code{mh-next-button}). If the end of the
2353 buffer is reached then the search wraps over to the start of the
2354 buffer. To move the cursor to the previous button, use the command
2355 @kbd{K S-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-prev-button}). If the beginning of the
2356 buffer is reached then the search wraps over to the end of the buffer.
2358 @cindex attachments, viewing
2359 @cindex viewing attachments
2360 @findex mh-folder-toggle-mime-part
2363 Another way to view the contents of a button is to use the command
2364 @kbd{K v} (@code{mh-folder-toggle-mime-part}). This command displays
2365 (or hides) the attachment associated with the button under the cursor.
2366 If the cursor is not located over a button, then the cursor first
2367 moves to the next button, wrapping to the beginning of the message if
2368 necessary. This command has the advantage over the previous commands
2369 of working from the MH-Folder buffer. You can also provide a numeric
2370 prefix argument (as in @kbd{4 K v}) to view the attachment labeled
2371 with that number. If Emacs does not know how to display the
2372 attachment, then Emacs offers to save the attachment in a file.
2374 @cindex @file{/etc/mailcap}
2375 @cindex files, @file{/etc/mailcap}
2376 @findex mailcap-mime-info
2377 @findex mh-display-with-external-viewer
2380 If Emacs does not know how to view an attachment, you could save it
2381 into a file and then run some program to open it. It is easier,
2382 however, to launch the program directly from MH-E with the command
2383 @kbd{K e} (@code{mh-display-with-external-viewer}). While you'll most
2384 likely use this to view spreadsheets and documents, it is also useful
2385 to use your browser to view HTML attachments with higher fidelity than
2386 what Emacs can provide. This command displays the attachment
2387 associated with the button under the cursor. If the cursor is not
2388 located over a button, then the cursor first moves to the next button,
2389 wrapping to the beginning of the message if necessary. You can provide
2390 a numeric prefix argument (as in @kbd{4 K e}) to view the attachment
2391 labeled with that number. This command tries to provide a reasonable
2392 default for the viewer by calling the Emacs function
2393 @code{mailcap-mime-info}. This function usually reads the file
2394 @file{/etc/mailcap}.
2396 @cindex attachments, saving
2397 @cindex saving attachments
2398 @findex mh-folder-save-mime-part
2401 Use the command @kbd{K o} (@code{mh-folder-save-mime-part}) to save
2402 attachments (the mnemonic is ``output''). This command saves the
2403 attachment associated with the button under the cursor. If the cursor
2404 is not located over a button, then the cursor first moves to the next
2405 button, wrapping to the beginning of the message if necessary. You can
2406 also provide a numeric prefix argument (as in @kbd{3 K o}) to save the
2407 attachment labeled with that number. This command prompts you for a
2408 filename and suggests a specific name if it is available.
2410 @cindex @command{mhn}
2411 @cindex @command{mhstore}
2412 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhn}
2413 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhstore}
2414 @findex mh-mime-save-parts
2416 @vindex mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory
2418 You can save all of the attachments at once with the command @kbd{K a}
2419 (@code{mh-mime-save-parts}). The attachments are saved in the
2420 directory specified by the option
2421 @code{mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory} unless you use a prefix
2422 argument (as in @kbd{C-u K a}) in which case you are prompted for the
2423 directory. These directories may be superseded by MH profile
2424 components, since this function calls on @command{mhstore}
2425 (@command{mhn}) to do the work.
2427 @vindex mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory
2429 The default value for the option
2430 @code{mh-mime-save-parts-default-directory} is @samp{Prompt Always} so
2431 that you are always prompted for the directory in which to save the
2432 attachments. However, if you usually use the same directory within a
2433 session, then you can set this option to @samp{Prompt the First Time}
2434 to avoid the prompt each time. you can make this directory permanent
2435 by choosing @samp{Directory} and entering the directory's name.
2437 @cindex attachments, inline
2438 @cindex inline attachments
2439 @findex mh-toggle-mime-buttons
2441 @vindex mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag
2443 The sender can request that attachments should be viewed inline so
2444 that they do not really appear like an attachment at all to the
2445 reader. Most of the time, this is desirable, so by default MH-E
2446 suppresses the buttons for inline attachments. On the other hand, you
2447 may receive code or HTML which the sender has added to his message as
2448 inline attachments so that you can read them in MH-E. In this case, it
2449 is useful to see the buttons so that you know you don't have to cut
2450 and paste the code into a file; you can simply save the attachment. If
2451 you want to make the buttons visible for inline attachments, you can
2452 use the command @kbd{K t} (@code{mh-toggle-mime-buttons}) to toggle
2453 the visibility of these buttons. You can turn on these buttons
2454 permanently by turning on the option
2455 @code{mh-display-buttons-for-inline-parts-flag}.
2457 MH-E cannot display all attachments inline however. It can display
2458 text (including @sc{html}) and images.
2460 @cindex header field, @samp{Content-Disposition:}
2461 @cindex inline images
2462 @cindex @samp{Content-Disposition:} header field
2463 @vindex mh-max-inline-image-height
2464 @vindex mh-max-inline-image-width
2466 Some older mail programs do not insert the needed
2467 plumbing@footnote{This plumbing is the @samp{Content-Disposition:}
2468 header field.} to tell MH-E whether to display the attachments inline
2469 or not. If this is the case, MH-E will display these images inline if
2470 they are smaller than the window. However, you might want to allow
2471 larger images to be displayed inline. To do this, you can change the
2472 options @code{mh-max-inline-image-width} and
2473 @code{mh-max-inline-image-height} from their default value of zero to
2474 a large number. The size of your screen is a good choice for these
2477 @cindex alternatives
2478 @cindex attachments, alternatives
2479 @vindex mh-display-buttons-for-alternatives-flag
2481 Sometimes, a mail program will produce multiple alternatives of an
2482 attachment in increasing degree of faithfulness to the original
2483 content. By default, only the preferred alternative is displayed. If
2484 the option @code{mh-display-buttons-for-alternatives-flag} is on, then
2485 the preferred part is shown inline and buttons are shown for each of
2486 the other alternatives.
2488 @vindex mm-discouraged-alternatives
2490 Many people prefer to see the @samp{text/plain} alternative rather
2491 than the @samp{text/html} alternative. To do this in MH-E, customize
2492 the option @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, and add
2493 @samp{text/html}. The next best alternative, if any, will be shown.
2496 @findex mh-folder-inline-mime-part
2498 You can view the raw contents of an attachment with the command @kbd{K
2499 i} (@code{mh-folder-inline-mime-part}). This command displays (or
2500 hides) the contents of the attachment associated with the button under
2501 the cursor verbatim. If the cursor is not located over a button, then
2502 the cursor first moves to the next button, wrapping to the beginning
2503 of the message if necessary. You can also provide a numeric prefix
2504 argument (as in @kbd{4 K i}) to view the attachment labeled with that
2507 For additional information on buttons, see
2509 @ref{Article Buttons,,,gnus}, and @ref{MIME Commands,,,gnus}.
2512 the chapters @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/gnus_101.html#SEC101,
2513 Article Buttons} and
2514 @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/gnus_108.html#SEC108, MIME Commands}
2515 in the @cite{The Gnus Manual}.
2518 @node HTML, Digests, Viewing Attachments, Reading Mail
2524 MH-E can display messages that have been sent in HTML@footnote{This
2525 feature depends on a version of Gnus that is at least 5.10.}. The
2526 content of the message will appear in the MH-Show buffer as you would
2527 expect if the entire message is HTML, or there is an inline HTML body
2528 part. However, if there is an HTML body part that is an attachment,
2529 then you'll see a button like this:
2532 [1. text/html; foo.html]...
2535 To see how to read the contents of this body part, see @ref{Viewing
2538 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
2540 The browser that MH-E uses is determined by the option
2541 @code{mm-text-html-renderer}. The default setting is set automatically
2542 based upon the presence of a known browser on your system. If you wish
2543 to use a different browser, then set this option accordingly. See the
2544 documentation for the browser you use for additional information on
2545 how to use it. In particular, find and disable the option to render
2546 images as this can tip off spammers that the email address they have
2549 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
2551 If you're confused about which @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to use,
2552 here's a brief description of each, sorted by popularity, that
2553 includes the results of a quick poll of MH-E users from 2005-12-23.
2556 @cindex browser, @samp{w3m}
2561 The @samp{w3m} browser requires an external program. It's quick,
2562 produces pretty nice output, and best of all, it's the only browser
2563 that highlights links. These can be clicked with @kbd{Mouse-2} to view
2564 the content of the link in @samp{w3m} or with @kbd{S-Mouse-2} to view
2565 the content of the link in an external browser. The @samp{w3m} browser
2566 handles tables well and actually respects the table's width parameter
2567 (which can cause text to wrap if the author didn't anticipate that the
2568 page would be viewed in Emacs).
2569 @c -------------------------
2570 @cindex browser, @samp{w3m-standalone}
2571 @cindex @samp{w3m-standalone}
2572 @item @samp{w3m-standalone} 3
2573 This browser, along with @samp{nil} for the external browser, are the
2574 only choices that work without having to download a separate lisp
2575 package or external program. This browser is quick, but does not show
2576 links. It handles simple tables but some tables get rendered much
2577 wider than the Emacs frame. This browser was the only one not to
2578 handle the escape @samp{–} (it printed a @samp{?}), but it did
2579 render @samp{®}.
2580 @c -------------------------
2581 @cindex browser, @samp{links}
2582 @cindex @samp{links}
2583 @item @samp{links} 1
2584 The @samp{links} browser requires an external program. It's quick, and
2585 produces nicer output than @samp{lynx} on single column mails in
2586 tables. However, it doesn't show links and it doesn't do as nice a job
2587 on multi-column tables as some lines wrap. At least it fits in 80
2588 columns and thus seems better than @samp{w3} and
2589 @samp{w3m-standalone}. Converts escapes such as @samp{®} to (R).
2590 @c -------------------------
2591 @cindex browser, @samp{lynx}
2594 The @samp{lynx} browser requires an external program. It's quick and
2595 produces pretty decent output but it doesn't show links. It doesn't
2596 seem to do multi-column tables which makes output much cleaner. It
2597 centers the output and wraps long lines more than most. Handles
2599 @c -------------------------
2601 This choice obviously requires an external browser. Like
2602 @samp{w3m-standalone}, it works out of the box. With this setting,
2603 HTML messages have a button for the body part which you can view with
2604 @kbd{K v} (@code{mh-folder-toggle-mime-part}).
2605 @c -------------------------
2606 @cindex browser, @samp{w3}
2609 This choice does not require an external program as all of the
2610 rendering is done in lisp. You do need to get the package separately.
2611 This browser is @strong{slow}, and doesn't appear to have been updated
2612 since 2001 and the author hasn't responded to my emails. It displays
2613 unknown tags instead of hiding them, so you get to see all the
2614 Microsoft crap in certain messages. Tends to make multi-column tables
2615 wider than even a full-screen Emacs can handle. Like @samp{w3m}, you
2616 can follow links, but you have to find them first as they are not
2617 highlighted. Performs well on single-column tables and handles escapes
2618 such as @samp{®}.
2619 @c -------------------------
2620 @cindex browser, @samp{html2text}
2621 @cindex @samp{html2text}
2622 @item @samp{html2text} 0
2623 The @samp{html2text} browser requires an external program. I noticed
2624 that it can do some nasty things with simple HTML mails (like filling
2625 the entire message as if it were one paragraph, including signature).
2626 On another message, it displayed half of the HTML tags for some
2630 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
2632 For a couple more sources of information about
2633 @code{mm-text-html-renderer},
2635 @xref{Display Customization,,,emacs-mime}, and the documentation for
2636 the Gnus command @kbd{W h} (@pxref{Article Washing,,,gnus},).
2639 see section @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/emacs-mime_6.html,
2640 Display Customization} in the @cite{The Emacs MIME Manual} and the the
2641 documentation for the Gnus command @kbd{W h} (see section
2642 @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/gnus_99.html, Article Washing} in the
2643 @cite{The Gnus Manual}).
2646 @node Digests, Reading PGP, HTML, Reading Mail
2650 @findex mh-page-digest
2651 @findex mh-page-digest-backwards
2657 A digest is a message that contains other messages. Special MH-E
2658 commands let you read digests conveniently. You can use @key{SPC} and
2659 @key{BS} to page through the digest as if it were a normal message,
2660 but if you wish to skip to the next message in the digest, use
2661 @kbd{D @key{SPC}} (@code{mh-page-digest}). To return to a previous message,
2662 use @kbd{D @key{BS}} (@code{mh-page-digest-backwards}).
2664 @cindex @command{burst}
2665 @cindex MH commands, @command{burst}
2666 @cindex MH-Folder Show mode
2667 @cindex modes, MH-Folder Show
2668 @findex mh-burst-digest
2673 Another handy command is @kbd{D b} (@code{mh-burst-digest}). This
2674 command uses the MH command @command{burst}@footnote{See the section
2675 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/burdig.html, Bursting Messages} in the MH
2676 book.} to break out each message in the digest into its own message.
2677 Using this command, you can quickly delete unwanted messages, like
2678 this: Once the digest is split up, toggle out of MH-Folder Show mode
2679 with @kbd{t} (@pxref{Folders}) so that the scan lines fill the screen
2680 and messages aren't displayed. Then use @kbd{d} (@pxref{Reading Mail})
2681 to quickly delete messages that you don't want to read (based on the
2682 @samp{Subject:} header field). You can also burst the digest to reply
2683 directly to the people who posted the messages in the digest. One
2684 problem you may encounter is that the @samp{From:} header fields are
2685 preceded with a @samp{>} so that your reply can't create the
2686 @samp{To:} field correctly. In this case, you must correct the
2687 @samp{To:} field yourself. This is described later (@pxref{Editing
2690 @node Reading PGP, Printing, Digests, Reading Mail
2691 @section Signed and Encrypted Messages
2699 @cindex encrypted messages
2701 @cindex signed messages
2703 You can read encrypted or signed PGP or GPG messages with
2704 MH-E@footnote{This feature depends on post-5.10 versions of Gnus.
2705 @cite{MIME Security with OpenPGP} is documented in
2706 @uref{http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3156.txt, RFC 3156}. However,
2707 MH-E can also decrypt old-style PGP messages that are not in MIME
2708 format.}. This section assumes that you already have a good
2709 understanding of GPG and have set up your keys appropriately.
2711 If someone sends you a signed message, here is what you'll see:
2715 [[PGP Signed Part:Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>]]
2716 This is a signed message.
2718 [[End of PGP Signed Part]]
2724 @cindex signed messages
2726 If the key for the given signature is not in your keychain, you'll be
2727 given the opportunity to fetch the key from a key server and verify
2728 the key. If the message is really large, the verification process can
2729 take a long time. You can press @kbd{C-g} at any time to
2730 cancel@footnote{Unfortunately in the current version, the validation
2731 process doesn't display a message so it appears that MH-E has hung. We
2732 hope that this will be fixed in the future.}.
2734 If the signature doesn't check out, you might see something like this:
2738 [[PGP Signed Part:Failed]]
2739 This is a signed message.
2740 This is garbage added after the signature was made.
2742 [[End of PGP Signed Part]]
2746 @cindex decrypting messages
2748 If someone sends you an encrypted message, MH-E will ask for your
2749 passphrase to decrypt the message. You should see something like this:
2753 [[PGP Encrypted Part:OK]]
2755 [[PGP Signed Part:Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>]]
2756 This is the secret message.
2758 [[End of PGP Signed Part]]
2760 [[End of PGP Encrypted Part]]
2764 If there is a problem decrypting the message, the button will say:
2767 [[PGP Encrypted Part:Failed]]
2770 You can read the contents of this button using the methods described in
2771 @ref{Viewing Attachments}. If the message were corrupted, you'd see
2775 [[PGP Encrypted Part:Failed]
2776 Invalid base64 data]
2779 If your passphrase were incorrect, you'd see something like this:
2782 [GNUPG:] ENC_TO CD9C88BB610BD9AD 1 0
2783 [GNUPG:] USERID_HINT CD9C88BB610BD9AD Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
2784 [GNUPG:] NEED_PASSPHRASE CD9C88BB610BD9AD CD9C88BB610BD9AD 1 0
2785 [GNUPG:] BAD_PASSPHRASE CD9C88BB610BD9AD
2786 gpg: encrypted with 1024-bit RSA key, ID 610BD9AD, created 1997-09-09
2787 "Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>"
2788 gpg: public key decryption failed: bad passphrase
2789 [GNUPG:] BEGIN_DECRYPTION
2790 [GNUPG:] DECRYPTION_FAILED
2791 gpg: decryption failed: secret key not available
2792 [GNUPG:] END_DECRYPTION
2794 gpg exited abnormally: '2'
2797 @vindex mh-show-pgg-bad
2798 @vindex mh-show-pgg-good
2799 @vindex mh-show-pgg-unknown
2801 The appearance of the buttons is controlled by the faces
2802 @code{mh-show-pgg-good}, @code{mh-show-pgg-bad}, and
2803 @code{mh-show-pgg-unknown} depending on the validity of the signature.
2804 The latter is used whether the signature is unknown or untrusted.
2806 @cindex @samp{pgg} customization group
2808 @cindex customization group, @samp{pgg}
2810 The @samp{pgg} customization group may have some settings which may
2813 See @cite{The PGG Manual}.
2816 @xref{Top, , The PGG Manual, pgg, The PGG Manual}.
2820 @uref{http://www.dk.xemacs.org/Documentation/packages/html/pgg.html,
2821 @cite{The PGG Manual}}.
2824 @node Printing, Files and Pipes, Reading PGP, Reading Mail
2825 @section Printing Your Mail
2828 @findex mh-ps-print-msg
2829 @findex mh-ps-print-msg-file
2832 @vindex mh-lpr-command-format
2833 @vindex mh-print-background-flag
2835 To print messages in MH-E, use the command @kbd{P p}
2836 (@code{mh-ps-print-msg}). You can print all the messages in a range
2837 (as in @kbd{C-u P p 1 3 5-7 last:5 frombob @key{RET}},
2838 @pxref{Ranges}). You can also send the output to a file with @kbd{P f}
2839 (@code{mh-ps-print-msg-file}). This command will print inline text
2840 attachments but will not decrypt messages. However, when a message is
2841 displayed in an MH-Show buffer, then that buffer is used verbatim for
2842 printing with the caveat that only text attachments, if opened inline,
2843 are printed. Therefore, encrypted messages can be printed by showing
2844 and decrypting them first. The commands @kbd{P p} and @kbd{P f} do not
2845 use the options @code{mh-lpr-command-format} or
2846 @code{mh-print-background-flag}, described below.
2848 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-color
2850 @vindex ps-print-color-p
2852 Colors are emulated on black-and-white printers with shades of gray.
2853 This might produce illegible output, even if your screen colors only
2854 use shades of gray. If this is the case, try using the command @kbd{P
2855 C} (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-color}) to toggle between color, no
2856 color, and a black and white representation of the colors and see
2857 which works best. You change this setting permanently by customizing
2858 the option @code{ps-print-color-p}.
2860 @findex mh-ps-print-toggle-faces
2863 Another related function is the command @kbd{P F}
2864 (@code{mh-ps-print-toggle-faces}). This command toggles between using
2865 faces and not. When faces are enabled, the printed message will look
2866 very similar to the message in the MH-Show buffer.
2868 @cindex ps-print package
2869 @cindex Emacs, packages, ps-print
2871 MH-E uses the @samp{ps-print} package to do the printing, so you can
2872 customize the printing further by going to the @samp{ps-print}
2873 customization group.
2875 @cindex @command{lpr}
2876 @cindex @command{mhl}
2877 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhl}
2878 @cindex Unix commands, @command{lpr}
2879 @findex mh-print-msg
2882 An alternative to using the @samp{ps-print} package is the command
2883 @kbd{P l} (@code{mh-print-msg}) (the @i{l} is for @i{l}ine printer or
2884 @i{l}pr). You can print all the messages in a range. The message is
2885 formatted with @command{mhl}@footnote{See the section
2886 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/shomes.html#Usisho, Using mhl} in the MH
2887 book.} and printed with the @command{lpr} command.
2892 @vindex mh-lpr-command-format
2893 @vindex mh-print-background-flag
2895 The command @kbd{P l} uses two options. The option
2896 @code{mh-lpr-command-format} contains the Unix command line which
2897 performs the actual printing. The string can contain one escape,
2898 @samp{%s}, which is replaced by the name of the folder and the message
2899 number and is useful for print job names. The default setting is
2900 @code{"lpr -J '%s'"}. I use @code{"mpage -h'%s' -b Letter -H1of -mlrtb
2901 -P"} which produces a nice header and adds a bit of margin so the text
2902 fits within my printer's margins. Normally messages are printed in the
2903 foreground. If this is slow on your system, you may elect to turn on
2904 the option @code{mh-print-background-flag} to print in the background.
2905 If you do this, do not delete the message until it is printed or else
2906 the output may be truncated. These options are not used by the
2907 commands @kbd{P p} or @kbd{P f}.
2909 @node Files and Pipes, Navigating, Printing, Reading Mail
2910 @section Files and Pipes
2914 @findex mh-refile-or-write-again
2915 @findex mh-write-msg-to-file
2919 MH-E does offer a couple of commands that are not a part of MH@. The
2920 first one, @kbd{>} (@code{mh-write-msg-to-file}), writes a message to
2921 a file. You are prompted for the filename. If the file already exists,
2922 the message is appended to it. You can also write the message to the
2923 file without the header by specifying a prefix argument (such as
2924 @kbd{C-u > /tmp/foobar @key{RET}}). Subsequent writes to the same file
2925 can be made with the command @kbd{!}
2926 (@code{mh-refile-or-write-again}).
2932 You can also pipe the message through a Unix shell command with the
2933 command @kbd{|} (@code{mh-pipe-msg}). You are prompted for the Unix
2934 command through which you wish to run your message. If you give a
2935 prefix argument to this command, the message header is included in the
2936 text passed to the command (the contrived example @kbd{C-u | lpr}
2937 would be done with the @kbd{l} command instead).
2939 @cindex @command{shar}
2940 @cindex @command{uuencode}
2941 @cindex Unix commands, @command{shar}
2942 @cindex Unix commands, @command{uuencode}
2943 @findex mh-store-msg
2945 @vindex mh-store-default-directory
2947 If the message is a shell archive @command{shar} or has been run
2948 through @command{uuencode} use @kbd{X s} (@code{mh-store-msg}) to
2949 extract the body of the message. The default directory for extraction
2950 is the current directory; however, you have a chance to specify a
2951 different extraction directory. The next time you use this command,
2952 the default directory is the last directory you used. If you would
2953 like to change the initial default directory, customize the option
2954 @code{mh-store-default-directory}, change the value from
2955 @samp{Current} to @samp{Directory}, and then enter the name of the
2956 directory for storing the content of these messages.
2958 @findex mh-store-buffer
2962 By the way, @kbd{X s} calls the Emacs Lisp function
2963 @code{mh-store-buffer}. I mention this because you can use it directly
2964 if you're editing a buffer that contains a file that has been run
2965 through @command{uuencode} or @command{shar}. For example, you can
2966 extract the contents of the current buffer in your home directory by
2967 typing @kbd{M-x mh-store-buffer @key{RET} ~ @key{RET}}.
2969 @node Navigating, Miscellaneous Commands and Options, Files and Pipes, Reading Mail
2972 @cindex moving between messages
2974 @findex mh-first-msg
2977 @findex mh-next-undeleted-msg
2978 @findex mh-next-unread-msg
2979 @findex mh-previous-undeleted-msg
2980 @findex mh-previous-unread-msg
2989 To move on to the next message, use the command @kbd{n}
2990 (@code{mh-next-undeleted-msg}); use @kbd{p}
2991 (@code{mh-previous-undeleted-msg}) to read the previous message. To
2992 move to the next unread message, use @kbd{M-n}
2993 (@code{mh-next-unread-msg}); use @kbd{M-p}
2994 (@code{mh-previous-unread-msg}) to move to the previous unread
2995 message. These commands can be given a prefix argument to specify how
2996 many messages to skip (for example, @kbd{5 n}). You can also move to a
2997 specific message with @kbd{g} (@code{mh-goto-msg}). You can enter the
2998 message number either before or after typing @kbd{g}. In the latter
2999 case, Emacs prompts you. Finally, you can go to the first or last
3000 message with @kbd{M-<} (@code{mh-first-msg}) and @kbd{M->}
3001 (@code{mh-last-msg}) respectively.
3003 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3004 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3006 @findex previous-line
3011 You can also use the Emacs commands @kbd{C-p} (@code{previous-line})
3012 and @kbd{C-n} (@code{next-line}) to move up and down the scan lines in
3013 the MH-Folder window. These commands can be used in conjunction with
3014 @key{RET} to look at deleted or refiled messages.
3016 @cindex deleting messages
3017 @findex mh-delete-msg
3022 To mark a message for deletion, use the command @kbd{d}
3023 (@code{mh-delete-msg}). A @samp{D} is placed by the message in the
3024 scan window, and the next undeleted message is displayed. If the
3025 previous command had been @kbd{p}, then the next message displayed is
3026 the first undeleted message previous to the message just deleted. Use
3027 @kbd{n} to force subsequent @kbd{d} commands to move forward to the
3028 next undeleted message after deleting the message under the cursor.
3029 You may also specify a range (for example, @kbd{C-u d 1 3 5-7 last:5
3030 frombob @key{RET}}, @pxref{Ranges}).
3032 @findex mh-delete-msg-no-motion
3035 The command @kbd{C-d} (@code{mh-delete-msg-no-motion}) marks the
3036 message (or messages in range) for deletion but leaves the cursor at
3037 the current message in case you wish to perform other operations on
3040 @findex mh-delete-subject
3041 @findex mh-delete-subject-or-thread
3042 @findex mh-thread-delete
3048 And to delete more messages faster, you can use @kbd{k}
3049 (@code{mh-delete-subject-or-thread}) to delete all the messages with
3050 the same subject as the current message. This command puts these
3051 messages in a sequence named @samp{subject}. You can undo this action
3052 by using @kbd{u} (@code{mh-undo}) with a prefix argument and then
3053 specifying the @samp{subject} sequence. However, if the buffer is
3054 displaying a threaded view of the folder then @kbd{k} behaves like
3055 @kbd{T d} (@code{mh-thread-delete}). @xref{Threading}.
3057 @findex mh-execute-commands
3060 However you mark a message for deletion, the command @kbd{x}
3061 (@code{mh-execute-commands}) actually carries out the deletion
3064 @vindex mh-delete-msg-hook
3066 The hook @code{mh-delete-msg-hook} is called after you mark a message
3067 for deletion. For example, a past maintainer of MH-E used this once
3068 when he kept statistics on his mail usage.
3070 @node Miscellaneous Commands and Options, , Navigating, Reading Mail
3071 @section Miscellaneous Commands and Options
3073 This section contains a few more miscellaneous commands and options.
3075 @cindex editing message
3079 There are times when you need to edit a message. For example, you may
3080 need to fix a broken Content-Type header field. You can do this with
3081 the command @kbd{M} (@code{mh-modify}). It displays the raw message in
3082 an editable buffer. When you are done editing, save and kill the
3083 buffer as you would any other.
3085 @findex mh-kill-folder
3086 @findex mh-pack-folder
3087 @vindex mh-do-not-confirm-flag
3089 Commands such as @code{mh-pack-folder} prompt to confirm whether to
3090 process outstanding moves and deletes or not before continuing.
3091 Turning on the option @code{mh-do-not-confirm-flag} means that these
3092 actions will be performed---which is usually desired but cannot be
3093 retracted---without question@footnote{In previous versions of MH-E,
3094 this option suppressed the confirmation in @code{mh-kill-folder}.
3095 Since this kept most users from setting this option,
3096 @code{mh-kill-folder} was modified in version 6.0 to always ask for
3097 confirmation subject to @code{mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hook}.
3100 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3101 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3102 @vindex mh-summary-height
3104 The option @code{mh-summary-height} controls the number of scan lines
3105 displayed in the MH-Folder window, including the mode line. The
3106 default value of this option is @samp{Automatic} which means that the
3107 MH-Folder buffer will maintain the same proportional size if the frame
3108 is resized. If you'd prefer a fixed height, then choose the
3109 @samp{Fixed Size} option and enter the number of lines you'd like to
3112 @vindex mh-bury-show-buffer-flag
3114 Normally the buffer for displaying messages is buried at the bottom at
3115 the buffer stack. You may wish to disable this feature by turning off
3116 the option @code{mh-bury-show-buffer-flag}. One advantage of not
3117 burying the show buffer is that one can delete the show buffer more
3118 easily in an electric buffer list because of its proximity to its
3119 associated MH-Folder buffer. Try running @kbd{M-x
3120 electric-buffer-list} to see what I mean.
3122 @cindex @file{.emacs}
3123 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
3124 @cindex reading mail
3126 Before we leave this section, I'll include a function that I use as a
3127 front end to MH-E@footnote{Stephen Gildea's favorite binding is
3128 @kbd{(global-set-key "\C-cr" 'mh-rmail)}.}. It toggles between your
3129 working window configuration, which may be quite involved---windows
3130 filled with source, compilation output, man pages, and other
3131 documentation---and your MH-E window configuration. Like the rest of
3132 the customization described in this section, simply add the following
3133 code to @file{~/.emacs}.
3139 @findex mh-rmail, example
3143 (defvar my-mh-screen-saved nil
3144 "Set to non-@code{nil} when MH-E window configuration shown.")
3145 (defvar my-normal-screen nil "Normal window configuration.")
3146 (defvar my-mh-screen nil "MH-E window configuration.")
3148 (defun my-mh-rmail (&optional arg)
3149 "Toggle between MH-E and normal screen configurations.
3150 With non-@code{nil} or prefix argument, @i{inc} mailbox as well
3151 when going into mail."
3152 (interactive "P") ; @r{user callable function, P=prefix arg}
3153 (setq my-mh-screen-saved ; @r{save state}
3155 ;; @r{Bring up MH-E screen if arg or normal window configuration.}
3156 ;; @r{If arg or +inbox buffer doesn't exist, run mh-rmail.}
3157 ((or arg (null my-mh-screen-saved))
3158 (setq my-normal-screen (current-window-configuration))
3159 (if (or arg (null (get-buffer "+inbox")))
3161 (set-window-configuration my-mh-screen))
3162 t) ; @r{set my-mh-screen-saved to @code{t}}
3163 ;; @r{Otherwise, save MH-E screen and restore normal screen.}
3165 (setq my-mh-screen (current-window-configuration))
3166 (set-window-configuration my-normal-screen)
3167 nil)))) ; @r{set my-mh-screen-saved to nil}
3169 (global-set-key "\C-x\r" 'my-mh-rmail) ;@r{ call with C-x @key{RET}}
3176 If you type an argument (@kbd{C-u}) or if @code{my-mh-screen-saved} is
3177 @code{nil} (meaning a non-MH-E window configuration), the current
3178 window configuration is saved, either the @samp{+inbox} buffer is
3179 displayed or @code{mh-rmail} is run, and the MH-E window configuration
3180 is shown. Otherwise, the MH-E window configuration is saved and the
3181 original configuration is displayed.
3183 @node Folders, Sending Mail, Reading Mail, Top
3184 @chapter Organizing Your Mail with Folders
3186 @cindex @samp{Folder} menu
3187 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
3189 @cindex menu, @samp{Folder}
3190 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
3191 @cindex using folders
3193 This chapter discusses the things you can do with folders within MH-E.
3194 The commands in this chapter are also found in the @samp{Folder} and
3195 @samp{Message} menus.
3201 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
3202 @c -------------------------
3204 @findex mh-refile-or-write-again
3206 Repeat last output command (@code{mh-refile-or-write-again}).
3207 @c -------------------------
3208 @cindex @samp{Message > Copy Message to Folder...} menu item
3209 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Copy Message to Folder...}
3213 Copy range to folder (@code{mh-copy-msg}).
3214 @c -------------------------
3216 @findex mh-prefix-help
3218 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
3219 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
3220 @c -------------------------
3222 @findex mh-index-ticked-messages
3224 Display ticked messages (@code{mh-index-ticked-messages}).
3225 @c -------------------------
3229 Delete range from the @samp{unseen} sequence (@code{mh-catchup}).
3230 @c -------------------------
3232 @findex mh-kill-folder
3234 Remove folder (@code{mh-kill-folder}).
3235 @c -------------------------
3236 @cindex @samp{Folder > List Folders} menu item
3237 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > List Folders}
3239 @findex mh-list-folders
3241 List all folders (@code{mh-list-folders}).
3242 @c -------------------------
3243 @cindex @samp{Folder > View New Messages} menu item
3244 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > View New Messages}
3246 @findex mh-index-new-messages
3248 Display unseen messages (@code{mh-index-new-messages}).
3249 @c -------------------------
3250 @cindex @samp{Folder > Pack Folder} menu item
3251 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Pack Folder}
3253 @findex mh-pack-folder
3255 Pack folder (@code{mh-pack-folder}).
3256 @c -------------------------
3258 @findex mh-index-sequenced-messages
3260 Display messages in any sequence (@code{mh-index-sequenced-messages}).
3261 @c -------------------------
3262 @cindex @samp{Folder > Rescan Folder} menu item
3263 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Rescan Folder}
3265 @findex mh-rescan-folder
3267 Rescan folder (@code{mh-rescan-folder}).
3268 @c -------------------------
3269 @cindex @samp{Folder > Search...} menu item
3270 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Search...}
3274 Search your MH mail (@code{mh-search}).
3275 @c -------------------------
3276 @cindex @samp{Folder > Sort Folder} menu item
3277 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Sort Folder}
3279 @findex mh-sort-folder
3281 Sort folder (@code{mh-sort-folder}).
3282 @c -------------------------
3284 @findex mh-undo-folder
3286 Undo all refiles and deletes in the current folder (@code{mh-undo-folder}).
3287 @c -------------------------
3288 @cindex @samp{Folder > Visit a Folder...} menu item
3289 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Visit a Folder...}
3291 @findex mh-visit-folder
3293 Visit folder (@code{mh-visit-folder}).
3294 @c -------------------------
3295 @cindex @samp{Message > Refile Message} menu item
3296 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Refile Message}
3298 @findex mh-refile-msg
3300 Refile (output) range into folder (@code{mh-refile-msg}).
3301 @c -------------------------
3302 @cindex @samp{Folder > Quit MH-E} menu item
3303 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Quit MH-E}
3307 Quit the current MH-E folder (@code{mh-quit}).
3308 @c -------------------------
3309 @cindex @samp{Folder > Toggle Show/Folder} menu item
3310 @cindex menu item, @samp{Folder > Toggle Show/Folder}
3312 @findex mh-toggle-showing
3314 Toggle between MH-Folder and MH-Folder Show modes
3315 (@code{mh-toggle-showing}).
3316 @c -------------------------
3317 @cindex @samp{Message > Undo Delete/Refile} menu item
3318 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Undo Delete/Refile}
3322 Undo pending deletes or refiles in range (@code{mh-undo}).
3323 @c -------------------------
3324 @cindex @samp{Message > Execute Delete/Refile} menu item
3325 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Execute Delete/Refile}
3327 @findex mh-execute-commands
3329 Process outstanding delete and refile requests
3330 (@code{mh-execute-commands}).
3333 @cindex @samp{mh-folder} customization group
3334 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-folder}
3336 The @samp{mh-folder} customization group is used to tune these
3340 @item mh-new-messages-folders
3341 Folders searched for the @samp{unseen} sequence (default:
3343 @c -------------------------
3344 @item mh-ticked-messages-folders
3345 Folders searched for @code{mh-tick-seq} (default: @code{t}).
3346 @c -------------------------
3347 @item mh-large-folder
3348 The number of messages that indicates a large folder (default: 200).
3349 @c -------------------------
3350 @item mh-recenter-summary-flag
3351 On means to recenter the summary window (default: @samp{off}).
3352 @c -------------------------
3353 @item mh-recursive-folders-flag
3354 On means that commands which operate on folders do so recursively
3355 (default: @samp{off}).
3356 @c -------------------------
3358 Additional arguments for @command{sortm} (default: @code{nil}).
3361 The following hooks are available.
3364 @item mh-after-commands-processed-hook
3365 Hook run by @kbd{x} after performing outstanding refile and delete
3366 requests (default: @code{nil}).
3367 @c -------------------------
3368 @item mh-before-commands-processed-hook
3369 Hook run by @kbd{x} before performing outstanding refile and delete
3370 requests (default: @code{nil}).
3371 @c -------------------------
3372 @item mh-before-quit-hook
3373 Hook run by q before quitting MH-E (default: @code{nil}).
3374 @c -------------------------
3375 @item mh-folder-mode-hook
3376 Hook run by @code{mh-folder-mode} when visiting a new folder (default:
3378 @c -------------------------
3379 @item mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hook
3380 Abnormal hook run at the beginning of @code{mh-kill-folder} (default:
3381 @code{'mh-search-p}).
3382 @c -------------------------
3384 Hook run by q after quitting MH-E (default: @code{nil}).
3385 @c -------------------------
3386 @item mh-refile-msg-hook
3387 Hook run by o after marking each message for refiling (default:
3391 The following faces are available for customizing the appearance of
3392 the MH-Folder buffer. @xref{Scan Line Formats}.
3395 @item mh-folder-address
3397 @c -------------------------
3398 @item mh-folder-body
3400 @c -------------------------
3401 @item mh-folder-cur-msg-number
3402 Current message number face.
3403 @c -------------------------
3404 @item mh-folder-date
3406 @c -------------------------
3407 @item mh-folder-deleted
3408 Deleted message face.
3409 @c -------------------------
3410 @item mh-folder-followup
3412 @c -------------------------
3413 @item mh-folder-msg-number
3414 Message number face.
3415 @c -------------------------
3416 @item mh-folder-refiled
3417 Refiled message face.
3418 @c -------------------------
3419 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
3420 @vindex mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
3421 @item mh-folder-sent-to-me-hint
3422 Fontification hint face in messages sent directly to us. The detection
3423 of messages sent to us is governed by the scan format
3424 @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} and regular expression
3425 @code{mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp}.
3426 @c -------------------------
3427 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
3428 @vindex mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
3429 @item mh-folder-scan-format
3430 Sender face in messages sent directly to us. The detection of messages
3431 sent to us is governed by the scan format @code{mh-scan-format-nmh}
3432 and regular expression @code{mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp}.
3433 @c -------------------------
3434 @item mh-folder-subject
3436 @c -------------------------
3437 @item mh-folder-tick
3438 Ticked message face.
3439 @c -------------------------
3444 @vindex mh-folder-mode-hook
3446 The hook @code{mh-folder-mode-hook} is called when visiting a new
3447 folder in MH-Folder mode. This could be used to set your own key
3448 bindings, for example:
3450 @vindex mh-folder-mode-hook, example
3454 (defvar my-mh-init-done nil
3455 "Non-@code{nil} when one-time MH-E settings made.")
3457 (defun my-mh-folder-mode-hook ()
3458 "Hook to set key bindings in MH-Folder mode."
3459 (if (not my-mh-init-done) ; @r{only need to bind the keys once }
3461 (local-set-key "//" 'my-search-msg)
3462 (local-set-key "b" 'mh-burst-digest) ; @r{better use of @kbd{b}}
3463 (setq my-mh-init-done t))))
3465 (add-hook 'mh-folder-mode-hook 'my-mh-folder-mode-hook)
3467 (defun my-search-msg ()
3468 "Search for a regexp in the current message."
3469 (interactive) ; @r{user function}
3470 (save-window-excursion
3471 (other-window 1) ; @r{go to next window}
3472 (isearch-forward-regexp))) ; @r{string search; hit return}
3475 @i{Create additional key bindings via mh-folder-mode-hook}
3480 @cindex @command{folder}
3481 @cindex @command{refile}
3482 @cindex MH commands, @command{folder}
3483 @cindex MH commands, @command{refile}
3484 @findex mh-refile-msg
3486 @vindex mh-refile-msg-hook
3488 MH-E has analogies for each of the MH @command{folder} and
3489 @command{refile} commands@footnote{See the sections
3490 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/fol.html#Youfol, Your Current Folder:
3491 folder} and @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/fol.html#Movref, Moving and
3492 Linking Messages: refile} in the MH book.}. To refile a message in
3493 another folder, use the command @kbd{o} (@code{mh-refile-msg})
3494 (mnemonic: ``output''). You are prompted for the folder name
3495 (@pxref{Folder Selection}). Note that this command can also be used to
3496 create folders. If you specify a folder that does not exist, you will
3497 be prompted to create it. The hook @code{mh-refile-msg-hook} is called
3498 after a message is marked to be refiled.
3500 @findex mh-write-msg-to-file
3503 If you are refiling several messages into the same folder, you can use
3504 the command @kbd{!} (@code{mh-refile-or-write-again}) to repeat the
3505 last refile or write (for the description of @kbd{>}
3506 (@code{mh-write-msg-to-file}), @pxref{Files and Pipes}). You can use a
3507 range in either case (for example, @kbd{C-u o 1 3 5-7 last:5 frombob
3508 @key{RET}}, @pxref{Ranges}).
3510 @cindex expunging refiles and deletes
3511 @cindex undoing refiles and deletes
3515 If you've deleted a message or refiled it, but changed your mind, you
3516 can cancel the action before you've executed it. Use @kbd{u}
3517 (@code{mh-undo}) to undo a refile on or deletion of a single message.
3518 You can also undo refiles and deletes for messages that are found in a
3519 given range (@pxref{Ranges}).
3521 @findex mh-undo-folder
3524 Alternatively, you can use @kbd{F u} (@code{mh-undo-folder}) to undo
3525 all refiles and deletes in the current folder.
3527 @findex mh-execute-commands
3530 If you've marked messages to be deleted or refiled and you want to go
3531 ahead and delete or refile the messages, use @kbd{x}
3532 (@code{mh-execute-commands}). Many MH-E commands that may affect the
3533 numbering of the messages (such as @kbd{F r} or @kbd{F p}) will ask if
3534 you want to process refiles or deletes first and then either run
3535 @kbd{x} for you or undo the pending refiles and deletes.
3538 @vindex mh-after-commands-processed-hook
3539 @vindex mh-before-commands-processed-hook
3541 The command @kbd{x} runs @code{mh-before-commands-processed-hook}
3542 before the commands are processed and
3543 @code{mh-after-commands-processed-hook} after the commands are
3544 processed. Variables that are useful with the former hook include
3545 @code{mh-delete-list} and @code{mh-refile-list} which can be used to
3546 see which changes will be made to the current folder,
3547 @code{mh-current-folder}. Variables that are useful with the latter
3548 hook include @code{mh-folders-changed}, which lists which folders were
3549 affected by deletes and refiles. This list will always include the
3550 current folder @code{mh-current-folder}.
3556 If you wish to copy a message to another folder, you can use the
3557 command @kbd{c} (@code{mh-copy-msg}) (see the @option{-link} argument
3558 to @command{refile}(1)). Like the command @kbd{o}, this command
3559 prompts you for the name of the target folder and you can specify a
3560 range (@pxref{Ranges}). Note that unlike the command @kbd{o}, the copy
3561 takes place immediately. The original copy remains in the current
3565 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3566 @cindex MH-Folder Show mode
3567 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3568 @cindex modes, MH-Folder Show
3570 @findex mh-toggle-showing
3573 The command @kbd{t} (@code{mh-toggle-showing}) switches between
3574 MH-Folder mode and MH-Folder Show mode@footnote{For you Emacs wizards,
3575 this is implemented as an Emacs minor mode.}. MH-Folder mode turns off
3576 the associated show buffer so that you can perform operations on the
3577 messages quickly without reading them. This is an excellent way to
3578 prune out your junk mail or to refile a group of messages to another
3579 folder for later examination.
3581 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3582 @cindex MH-Show mode
3583 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3584 @cindex modes, MH-Show
3585 @cindex moving between messages
3587 @vindex mh-recenter-summary-flag
3589 When you use @kbd{t} to toggle from MH-Folder Show mode to MH-Folder
3590 mode, the MH-Show buffer is hidden and the MH-Folder buffer is left
3591 alone. Setting @code{mh-recenter-summary-flag} to a non-@code{nil}
3592 value causes the toggle to display as many scan lines as possible,
3593 with the cursor at the middle. The effect of
3594 @code{mh-recenter-summary-flag} is rather useful, but it can be
3595 annoying on a slow network connection.
3597 @findex mh-visit-folder
3599 @vindex mh-large-folder
3601 When you want to read the messages that you have refiled into folders,
3602 use the command @kbd{F v} (@code{mh-visit-folder}) to visit the
3603 folder. You are prompted for the folder name. The folder buffer will
3604 show just unseen messages if there are any; otherwise, it will show
3605 all the messages in the buffer as long there are fewer than
3606 @code{mh-large-folder} messages. If there are more, then you are
3607 prompted for a range of messages to scan. You can provide a prefix
3608 argument in order to specify a range of messages to show when you
3609 visit the folder (@pxref{Ranges}). In this case, regions are not used
3610 to specify the range and @code{mh-large-folder} is ignored. Note that
3611 this command can also be used to create folders. If you specify a
3612 folder that does not exist, you will be prompted to create it.
3617 If you forget where you've refiled your messages, you can find them
3618 using @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search}). @xref{Searching}.
3620 @cindex @command{procmail}
3621 @cindex @samp{unseen} sequence
3622 @cindex sequence, @samp{unseen}
3623 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
3624 @cindex unseen messages, viewing
3625 @findex mh-index-new-messages
3627 @vindex mh-new-messages-folders
3629 If you use a program such as @command{procmail} to file your incoming
3630 mail automatically, you can display new, unseen, messages using the
3631 command @kbd{F n} (@code{mh-index-new-messages}). All messages in the
3632 @samp{unseen} sequence from the folders in
3633 @code{mh-new-messages-folders} are listed. However, this list of
3634 folders can be overridden with a prefix argument: with a prefix
3635 argument, enter a space-separated list of folders, or nothing to
3638 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
3639 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
3640 @cindex ticked messages, viewing
3641 @findex mh-index-ticked-messages
3643 @vindex mh-ticked-messages-folders
3645 If you have ticked messages (@pxref{Sequences}), you can display them
3646 using the command @kbd{F '} (@code{mh-index-ticked-messages}). All
3647 messages in the @samp{tick} sequence from the folders in
3648 @code{mh-ticked-messages-folders} are listed. With a prefix argument,
3649 enter a space-separated list of folders, or nothing to search all
3652 @findex mh-index-sequenced-messages
3654 @vindex mh-new-messages-folders
3656 You can display messages in any sequence with the command @kbd{F q}
3657 (@code{mh-index-sequenced-messages}). All messages from the folders in
3658 @code{mh-new-messages-folders} in the sequence you provide are listed.
3659 With a prefix argument, enter a space-separated list of folders at the
3660 prompt, or nothing to search all folders.
3662 @vindex mh-new-messages-folders
3663 @vindex mh-recursive-folders-flag
3664 @vindex mh-ticked-messages-folders
3666 Set the options @code{mh-new-messages-folders} and
3667 @code{mh-ticked-messages-folders} to @samp{Inbox} to search the
3668 @samp{+inbox} folder or @samp{All} to search all of the top level
3669 folders. Otherwise, list the folders that should be searched with the
3670 @samp{Choose Folders} menu item. See @code{mh-recursive-folders-flag}.
3672 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
3673 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
3674 @findex mh-kill-folder
3675 @findex mh-list-folders
3676 @findex mh-pack-folder
3677 @findex mh-rescan-folder
3678 @findex mh-sort-folder
3685 Other commands you can perform on folders include: @kbd{F l}
3686 (@code{mh-list-folders}), to place a listing of all the folders in
3687 your mail directory in a buffer called @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
3688 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}); @kbd{F k} (@code{mh-kill-folder}), to remove
3689 a folder; @kbd{F S} (@code{mh-sort-folder}), to sort the messages by
3690 date (see @command{sortm}(1) to see how to sort by other criteria);
3691 @kbd{F p} (@code{mh-pack-folder}), to pack a folder, removing gaps
3692 from the numbering sequence; and @kbd{F r} (@code{mh-rescan-folder}),
3693 to rescan the folder, which is useful to grab all messages in your
3694 @samp{+inbox} after processing your new mail for the first time. If
3695 you don't want to rescan the entire folder, the commands @kbd{F r} or
3696 @kbd{F p} will accept a range (@pxref{Ranges}).
3699 @vindex mh-recursive-folders-flag
3701 By default, operations on folders work only one level at a time. Set
3702 @code{mh-recursive-folders-flag} to non-@code{nil} to operate on all
3703 folders. This mostly means that you'll be able to see all your folders
3704 when you press @key{TAB} when prompted for a folder name.
3708 @vindex mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hooks
3710 The hook @code{mh-kill-folder-suppress-prompt-hooks} is an abnormal
3711 hook run at the beginning of the command @kbd{k}. The hook functions
3712 are called with no arguments and should return a non-nil value to
3713 suppress the normal prompt when you remove a folder. This is useful
3714 for folders that are easily regenerated. The default value of
3715 @code{mh-search-p} suppresses the prompt on folders generated by
3719 @center @strong{NOTE}
3722 Use this hook with care. If there is a bug in your hook which returns
3723 @code{t} on @samp{+inbox} and you press @kbd{k} by accident in the
3724 @code{+inbox} folder, you will not be happy.
3728 @cindex @command{sortm}
3729 @cindex @file{.mh_profile}
3730 @cindex files, @file{.mh_profile}
3731 @cindex MH commands, @command{sortm}
3732 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{sortm:}
3733 @cindex @samp{sortm:} MH profile component
3735 @vindex mh-sortm-args
3737 The option @code{mh-sortm-args} holds extra arguments to pass on to
3738 the command @command{sortm}@footnote{See the section
3739 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/sorsor.html, Sorting Messages: sortm} in the
3740 MH book.} when a prefix argument is used with @kbd{F S}. Normally
3741 default arguments to @command{sortm} are specified in the MH profile.
3742 This option may be used to provide an alternate view. For example,
3743 @samp{'(\"-nolimit\" \"-textfield\" \"subject\")} is a useful setting.
3750 When you want to quit using MH-E and go back to editing, you can use
3751 the @kbd{q} (@code{mh-quit}) command. This buries the buffers of the
3752 current MH-E folder and restores the buffers that were present when
3753 you first ran @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}. It also removes any MH-E working
3754 buffers whose name begins with @samp{ *mh-} or @samp{*MH-E }
3755 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}). You can later restore your MH-E session by
3756 selecting the @samp{+inbox} buffer or by running @kbd{M-x mh-rmail}
3759 @findex mh-execute-commands
3761 @vindex mh-before-quit-hook
3762 @vindex mh-before-quit-hook, example
3763 @vindex mh-quit-hook
3764 @vindex mh-quit-hook, example
3766 The two hooks @code{mh-before-quit-hook} and @code{mh-quit-hook} are
3767 called by @kbd{q}. The former one is called before the quit occurs, so
3768 you might use it to perform any MH-E operations; you could perform
3769 some query and abort the quit or call @code{mh-execute-commands}, for
3770 example. The latter is not run in an MH-E context, so you might use it
3771 to modify the window setup. If you find that @kbd{q} buries a lot of
3772 buffers that you would rather remove, you can use both
3773 @code{mh-before-quit-hook} and @code{mh-quit-hook} to accomplish that.
3777 (defvar my-mh-folder-buffer-to-delete nil
3778 "Folder buffer that is being quit.")
3780 (defun my-mh-before-quit-hook ()
3781 "Save folder buffer that is to be deleted."
3782 (setq my-mh-folder-buffer-to-delete (current-buffer)))
3784 (defun my-mh-quit-hook ()
3785 "Kill folder buffer rather than just bury it."
3786 (set-buffer my-mh-folder-buffer-to-delete)
3787 (if (get-buffer mh-show-buffer)
3788 (kill-buffer mh-show-buffer))
3789 (kill-buffer (current-buffer)))
3791 @i{Kill MH-Folder buffer instead of burying it}
3795 @cindex folders, renaming
3796 @cindex renaming folders
3798 @findex dired-do-rename
3800 You can use dired to manipulate the folders themselves. For example, I
3801 renamed my @samp{+out} folder to the more common @samp{+outbox} by
3802 running dired on my mail directory (@kbd{M-x dired RET ~/Mail RET}),
3803 moving my cursor to @samp{out} and using the command @kbd{R}
3804 (@code{dired-do-rename}).
3806 @node Sending Mail, Editing Drafts, Folders, Top
3807 @chapter Sending Mail
3809 @cindex sending mail
3811 @kindex M-x mh-smail
3813 You can send a mail message in several ways. You can call @kbd{M-x
3814 mh-smail} directly, or from the command line like this:
3816 @cindex starting from command line
3819 $ @kbd{emacs -f mh-smail}
3822 @findex goto-address-at-point
3823 @vindex mail-user-agent
3825 There are some commands that need to send a mail message, such as
3826 @code{goto-address-at-point}. You can configure Emacs to have these
3827 commands use MH-E by setting the option @code{mail-user-agent} to
3828 @samp{Emacs interface to MH}.
3830 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
3831 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
3833 From within MH-E's MH-Folder mode, other methods of sending mail are
3834 available as well. These can also be found in the @samp{Message} menu.
3837 @cindex @samp{Message > Edit Message Again} menu item
3838 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Edit Message Again}
3840 @findex mh-edit-again
3842 Edit a message to send it again (@code{mh-edit-again}).
3843 @c -------------------------
3844 @cindex @samp{Message > Re-edit a Bounced Message} menu item
3845 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Re-edit a Bounced Message}
3847 @findex mh-extract-rejected-mail
3849 Edit a message that was returned by the mail system
3850 (@code{mh-extract-rejected-mail}).
3851 @c -------------------------
3852 @cindex @samp{Message > Forward Message...} menu item
3853 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Forward Message...}
3857 Forward message (@code{mh-forward}).
3858 @c -------------------------
3859 @cindex @samp{Message > Reply to Message...} menu item
3860 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Reply to Message...}
3864 Reply to a message (@code{mh-reply}).
3865 @c -------------------------
3866 @cindex @samp{Message > Compose a New Message} menu item
3867 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Compose a New Message}
3871 Compose a message (@code{mh-send}).
3872 @c -------------------------
3873 @cindex @samp{Message > Redistribute Message...} menu item
3874 @cindex menu item, @samp{Message > Redistribute Message...}
3876 @findex mh-redistribute
3878 Redistribute a message (@code{mh-redistribute}).
3879 @c -------------------------
3882 Compose a message with the MH mail system.
3883 @c -------------------------
3884 @findex mh-smail-other-window
3885 @item M-x mh-smail-other-window
3886 Compose a message with the MH mail system in other window.
3889 @cindex @samp{mh-sending-mail} customization group
3890 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-sending-mail}
3892 In addition, several options from the @samp{mh-sending-mail}
3893 customization group are useful when sending mail or replying to mail.
3894 They are summarized in the following table.
3897 @item mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag
3898 On means that messages are forwarded as attachments (default:
3900 @c -------------------------
3901 @item mh-compose-letter-function
3902 Hook run when starting a new draft (default: @code{nil}).
3903 @c -------------------------
3904 @item mh-compose-prompt-flag
3905 On means prompt for header fields when composing a new draft (default:
3907 @c -------------------------
3908 @item mh-forward-subject-format
3909 Format string for forwarded message subject (default: @code{"%s:
3911 @c -------------------------
3912 @item mh-insert-x-mailer-flag
3913 On means append an @samp{X-Mailer:} header field to the header
3914 (default: @samp{on}).
3915 @c -------------------------
3916 @item mh-redist-full-contents-flag
3917 On means the @command{dist} command needs entire letter for
3918 redistribution (default: @samp{off}).
3919 @c -------------------------
3920 @item mh-reply-default-reply-to
3921 Sets the person or persons to whom a reply will be sent (default:
3923 @c -------------------------
3924 @item mh-reply-show-message-flag
3925 On means the MH-Show buffer is displayed using @kbd{r}
3926 (@code{mh-reply}) (default: @samp{on}).
3929 The following hooks are available.
3932 @item mh-forward-hook
3933 Hook run by @code{mh-forward} on a forwarded letter (default:
3935 @c -------------------------
3936 @item mh-letter-mode-hook
3937 Hook run by @code{mh-letter-mode} on a new letter (default:
3941 The functions and options introduced here are explained in more detail
3942 in the following sections.
3952 @node Composing, Replying, Sending Mail, Sending Mail
3955 @cindex @file{.emacs}
3956 @cindex MH-Folder mode
3957 @cindex composing mail
3959 @cindex files, @file{.emacs}
3960 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
3961 @cindex sending mail
3963 @findex mh-smail-other-window
3964 @kindex M-x mh-smail
3965 @kindex M-x mh-smail-other-window
3967 Outside of an MH-Folder buffer, you must call either @kbd{M-x
3968 mh-smail} or @kbd{M-x mh-smail-other-window} to compose a new message.
3969 The former command always creates a two-window layout with the current
3970 buffer on top and the draft on the bottom. Use the latter command if
3971 you would rather preserve the window layout. You may find adding the
3972 following key bindings to @file{~/.emacs} useful:
3975 (global-set-key "\C-xm" 'mh-smail)
3976 (global-set-key "\C-x4m" 'mh-smail-other-window)
3979 @cindex draft folder
3980 @cindex MH-Letter mode
3981 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
3985 From within a MH-Folder buffer, you can simply use the command @kbd{m}
3986 (@code{mh-send}). However you invoke @code{mh-send}, your letter
3987 appears in an Emacs buffer whose mode is MH-Letter (to see what the
3988 buffer looks like, @pxref{Sending Mail Tour}). MH-Letter mode allows
3989 you to edit your message, to check the validity of the recipients, to
3990 insert attachments and other messages into your message, and to send
3991 the message. We'll go more into depth about editing a
3992 @dfn{draft}@footnote{I highly recommend that you use a @dfn{draft
3993 folder} so that you can edit several drafts in parallel. To do so,
3994 create a folder named @samp{+drafts} for example, and add the profile
3995 component @samp{Draft-Folder: drafts} (see @code{mh-profile}(5)).} (a
3996 message you're composing) in just a moment (@pxref{Editing Drafts}).
3998 @vindex mh-compose-prompt-flag
4000 If you prefer to be prompted for the recipient and subject fields
4001 before the MH-Letter buffer appears, turn on the option
4002 @code{mh-compose-prompt-flag}.
4004 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Mailer:}
4005 @cindex @samp{X-Mailer:} header field
4006 @vindex mh-insert-x-mailer-flag
4008 MH-E adds an @samp{X-Mailer:} header field to the header that includes
4009 the version of MH-E and Emacs that you are using. If you don't want to
4010 participate in our marketing, you can turn off the option
4011 @code{mh-insert-x-mailer-flag}.
4013 @cindex @command{repl}
4014 @cindex @file{components}
4015 @cindex MH commands, @command{repl}
4016 @cindex MH-Letter mode
4018 @cindex files, @file{components}
4019 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
4021 @vindex mail-mode-hook
4022 @vindex mh-letter-mode-hook
4023 @vindex text-mode-hook
4025 Two hooks are provided to run commands on your freshly created draft.
4026 The first hook, @code{mh-letter-mode-hook}, allows you to do some
4027 processing before editing a letter@footnote{Actually, because
4028 MH-Letter mode inherits from Mail mode, the hooks
4029 @code{text-mode-hook} and @code{mail-mode-hook} are run (in that
4030 order) before @code{mh-letter-mode-hook}.}. For example, you may wish
4031 to modify the header after @command{repl} has done its work, or you
4032 may have a complicated @file{components} file and need to tell MH-E
4033 where the cursor should go. Here's an example of how you would use
4036 @findex mh-insert-signature, example
4040 (defvar letter-mode-init-done-flag nil
4041 "Non-nil means one-time MH-E settings have been made.")
4043 (defun my-mh-letter-mode-hook ()
4044 "Prepare letter for editing."
4045 (when (not letter-mode-init-done) ; @r{only need to bind the keys once}
4046 (local-set-key "\C-ctb" 'add-enriched-text)
4047 (local-set-key "\C-cti" 'add-enriched-text)
4048 (local-set-key "\C-ctf" 'add-enriched-text)
4049 (local-set-key "\C-cts" 'add-enriched-text)
4050 (local-set-key "\C-ctB" 'add-enriched-text)
4051 (local-set-key "\C-ctu" 'add-enriched-text)
4052 (local-set-key "\C-ctc" 'add-enriched-text)
4053 (setq letter-mode-init-done t))
4055 (goto-char (point-max)) ; @r{go to end of message to}
4056 (mh-insert-signature))) ; @r{insert signature}
4058 @i{Prepare draft for editing via mh-letter-mode-hook}
4063 The function, @code{add-enriched-text} is defined in the example in
4064 @ref{Adding Attachments}.
4066 @vindex mh-compose-letter-function
4067 @vindex mh-letter-mode-hook
4069 The second hook, a function really, is
4070 @code{mh-compose-letter-function}. Like @code{mh-letter-mode-hook}, it
4071 is called just before editing a new message; however, it is the last
4072 function called before you edit your message. The consequence of this
4073 is that you can write a function to write and send the message for
4074 you. This function is passed three arguments: the contents of the
4075 @samp{To:}, @samp{Subject:}, and @samp{Cc:} header fields.
4077 @node Replying, Forwarding, Composing, Sending Mail
4078 @section Replying to Mail
4080 @cindex @command{mhl}
4081 @cindex @file{mhl.reply}
4082 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhl}
4083 @cindex files, @file{mhl.reply}
4088 To compose a reply to a message, use the @kbd{r} (@code{mh-reply})
4091 When you reply to a message, you are first prompted with @samp{Reply
4092 to whom?}. You have several choices here.
4095 @multitable @columnfractions .20 .80
4096 @c @headitem Response @tab Reply Goes To
4097 @c XXX @headitem not yet supported by SourceForge's texi2pdf.
4098 @item @b{Response} @tab @b{Reply Goes To}
4099 @c -------------------------
4102 The person who sent the message. This is the default, so @key{RET} is
4104 @c -------------------------
4107 Replies to the sender, plus all recipients in the @samp{To:} header field.
4108 @c -------------------------
4109 @item @kbd{cc}@*@kbd{all}
4111 Forms a reply to the addresses in the @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header
4112 field if one exists; otherwise forms a reply to the sender, plus all
4117 @cindex @command{repl}
4118 @cindex MH commands, @command{repl}
4119 @vindex mh-reply-default-reply-to
4121 Depending on your answer, @command{repl}@footnote{See the section
4122 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reprep.html, Replying to Messages: repl} in
4123 the MH book.} is given a different argument to form your reply.
4124 Specifically, a choice of @kbd{from} or none at all runs @samp{repl
4125 -nocc all}, and a choice of @kbd{to} runs @samp{repl -cc to}. Finally,
4126 either @kbd{cc} or @kbd{all} runs @samp{repl -cc all -nocc me}. If you
4127 find that most of the time you specify one of these choices when you
4128 reply to a message, you can change the option
4129 @code{mh-reply-default-reply-to} from its default value of
4130 @samp{Prompt} to one of the choices listed above. You can always edit
4131 the recipients in the draft.
4133 @cindex @samp{repl:} MH profile component
4134 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{repl:}
4135 @cindex MH-Letter mode
4136 @cindex MH-Show mode
4138 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
4139 @cindex modes, MH-Show
4141 Two windows are then created. One window contains the message to which
4142 you are replying in an MH-Show buffer. Your draft, in MH-Letter mode
4143 (@pxref{Editing Drafts}), is in the other window. If the reply draft
4144 was not one that you expected, check the things that affect the
4145 behavior of @command{repl} which include the @samp{repl:} profile
4146 component and the @file{replcomps} and @file{replgroupcomps} files.
4148 If you supply a prefix argument (as in @kbd{C-u r}), the message you
4149 are replying to is inserted in your reply after having first been run
4150 through @command{mhl} with the format file @file{mhl.reply}. See
4151 @command{mhl}(1) or the section
4152 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/shomes.html#Usisho, Using mhl} in the MH
4153 book to see how you can modify the default @file{mhl.reply} file.
4155 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4157 Alternatively, you can customize the option @code{mh-yank-behavior}
4158 and choose one of its @samp{Automatically} variants to do the same
4159 thing. @xref{Inserting Letter}. If you do so, the prefix argument has
4162 Another way to include the message automatically in your draft is to
4163 use @samp{repl: -filter repl.filter} in your MH profile.
4165 @vindex mh-reply-show-message-flag
4167 If you include the message automatically, you can hide the MH-Show
4168 buffer by turning off the option @code{mh-reply-show-message-flag}.
4170 If you wish to customize the header or other parts of the reply draft,
4171 please see @command{repl}(1) and @code{mh-format}(5).
4173 @node Forwarding, Redistributing, Replying, Sending Mail
4174 @section Forwarding Mail
4176 @cindex @command{forw}
4179 @cindex MH commands, @command{forw}
4182 @vindex mh-forward-hook
4184 To forward a message, use the @kbd{f} (@code{mh-forward}) command. You
4185 are prompted for the @samp{To:} and @samp{cc:} recipients. You are
4186 given a draft to edit that looks like it would if you had run the MH
4187 command @command{forw}@footnote{See the section
4188 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/forfor.html, Forwarding Messages: forw} in
4189 the MH book.}. You can then add some text (@pxref{Editing Drafts}).
4190 You can forward several messages by using a range (@pxref{Ranges}).
4191 All of the messages in the range are inserted into your draft. The
4192 hook @code{mh-forward-hook} is called on the draft.
4194 @cindex @file{.mh_profile}
4195 @cindex files, @file{.mh_profile}
4196 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{forw:}
4197 @cindex @samp{forw:} MH profile component
4198 @vindex mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag
4200 By default, the option @code{mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag} is on
4201 which means that the forwarded messages are included as attachments.
4202 If you would prefer to forward your messages verbatim (as text,
4203 inline), then turn off this option. Forwarding messages verbatim works
4204 well for short, textual messages, but your recipient won't be able to
4205 view any non-textual attachments that were in the forwarded message.
4206 Be aware that if you have @samp{forw: -mime} in your MH profile, then
4207 forwarded messages will always be included as attachments regardless
4208 of the settings of @code{mh-compose-forward-as-mime-flag}.
4210 @vindex mh-forward-subject-format
4212 The format of the @samp{Subject:} header field for forwarded messages
4213 is controlled by the option @code{mh-forward-subject-format}. This
4214 option is a string which includes two escapes (@samp{%s}). The first
4215 @samp{%s} is replaced with the sender of the original message, and the
4216 second one is replaced with the original @samp{Subject:}. The default
4217 value of @code{"%s: %s"} takes a message with the header:
4221 To: Bill Wohler <wohler@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
4222 Subject: Re: 49er football
4223 From: Greg DesBrisay <gd@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
4227 and creates a subject header field of:
4230 Subject: Greg DesBrisay: Re: 49er football
4233 @node Redistributing, Editing Again, Forwarding, Sending Mail
4234 @section Redistributing Your Mail
4236 @cindex @command{dist}
4237 @cindex MH commands, @command{dist}
4238 @cindex redistributing
4239 @findex mh-redistribute
4242 The command @kbd{M-d} (@code{mh-redistribute}) is similar in function
4243 to forwarding mail, but it does not allow you to edit the message, nor
4244 does it add your name to the @samp{From:} header field. It appears to
4245 the recipient as if the message had come from the original sender.
4246 When you run this command, you are prompted for the recipients.
4248 @findex mh-edit-again
4251 For more information on redistributing messages, see
4252 @command{dist}(1). Also investigate the command @kbd{e}
4253 (@code{mh-edit-again}) for another way to redistribute messages
4254 (@pxref{Editing Again}).
4256 @cindex @command{send}
4257 @cindex MH commands, @command{send}
4258 @vindex mh-redist-full-contents-flag
4260 The option @code{mh-redist-full-contents-flag} must be turned on if
4261 @command{dist}@footnote{See the section
4262 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/disdis.html, Distributing Messages with
4263 dist} in the MH book.} requires the whole letter for redistribution,
4264 which is the case if @command{send}@footnote{See the section
4265 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/sensen.html, Sending Some Mail: comp send}
4266 in the MH book.} is compiled with the @sc{berk} option (which many
4267 people abhor). If you find that MH will not allow you to redistribute
4268 a message that has been redistributed before, turn off this option.
4270 @node Editing Again, , Redistributing, Sending Mail
4271 @section Editing Old Drafts and Bounced Messages
4273 @cindex @file{draft}
4274 @cindex files, @file{draft}
4275 @cindex re-editing drafts
4276 @findex mh-edit-again
4281 If you don't complete a draft for one reason or another, and if the
4282 draft buffer is no longer available, you can pick your draft up again
4283 with @kbd{e} (@code{mh-edit-again}). If you don't use a draft
4284 folder, your last @file{draft} file will be used. If you use draft
4285 folders, you'll need to visit the draft folder with @kbd{F v drafts
4286 @key{RET}}, use @kbd{n} to move to the appropriate message, and then
4287 use @kbd{e} to prepare the message for editing.
4291 The @kbd{e} command can also be used to take messages that were sent
4292 to you and to send them to more people.
4294 @cindex Mailer-Daemon
4295 @findex mh-extract-rejected-mail
4299 Don't use @kbd{e} to re-edit a message from a @i{Mailer-Daemon} who
4300 complained that your mail wasn't posted for some reason or another. In
4301 this case, use @kbd{E} (@code{mh-extract-rejected-mail}) to prepare
4302 the message for editing by removing the @i{Mailer-Daemon} envelope and
4303 unneeded header fields. Fix whatever addressing problem you had, and
4304 send the message again with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
4306 @node Editing Drafts, Aliases, Sending Mail, Top
4307 @chapter Editing a Draft
4309 @cindex @samp{Letter} menu
4310 @cindex MH-Letter mode
4312 @cindex editing draft
4313 @cindex menu, @samp{Letter}
4314 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
4316 When you edit a message that you want to send (called a @dfn{draft} in
4317 this case), the mode used is MH-Letter. This mode provides several
4318 commands in addition to the normal Emacs editing commands to help you
4319 edit your draft. These can also be found in the @samp{Letter} menu.
4323 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
4325 Perform completion or insert space (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}).
4326 @c -------------------------
4328 @findex mh-letter-complete
4330 Perform completion on header field or word preceding point
4331 (@code{mh-letter-complete}).
4332 @c -------------------------
4334 @findex mh-letter-confirm-address
4336 Flash alias expansion (@code{mh-letter-confirm-address}).
4337 @c -------------------------
4339 @findex mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent
4341 Cycle to next field (@code{mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent}).
4342 @c -------------------------
4344 @findex mh-letter-previous-header-field
4346 Cycle to the previous header field
4347 (@code{mh-letter-previous-header-field}).
4348 @c -------------------------
4352 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
4353 @c -------------------------
4354 @cindex @samp{Letter > Send This Draft} menu item
4355 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Send This Draft}
4357 @findex mh-send-letter
4359 Save draft and send message (@code{mh-send-letter}).
4360 @c -------------------------
4362 @findex mh-insert-identity
4364 Insert fields specified by the given identity
4365 (@code{mh-insert-identity}). @xref{Identities}.
4366 @c -------------------------
4367 @cindex @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MH)} menu item
4368 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MH)}
4370 @findex mh-mh-to-mime
4372 Compose @sc{mime} message from MH-style directives
4373 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime}).
4374 @c -------------------------
4380 Move to @samp{Mail-Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4381 @c -------------------------
4386 Move to @samp{Bcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4387 @c -------------------------
4392 Move to @samp{Cc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4393 @c -------------------------
4398 Move to @samp{Dcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4399 @c -------------------------
4405 Move to @samp{Fcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-fcc}).
4406 @c -------------------------
4411 Move to @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4412 @c -------------------------
4417 Move to @samp{From:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4418 @c -------------------------
4423 Move to @samp{Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4424 @c -------------------------
4429 Move to @samp{Subject:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4430 @c -------------------------
4435 Move to @samp{To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
4436 @c -------------------------
4437 @cindex @samp{Letter > Insert a Message...} menu item
4438 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Insert a Message...}
4440 @findex mh-insert-letter
4442 Insert a message (@code{mh-insert-letter}).
4443 @c -------------------------
4445 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt
4447 Add tag to encrypt the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt}).
4448 @c -------------------------
4449 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Forward...} menu item
4450 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Forward...}
4453 @findex mh-compose-forward
4456 Add tag to forward a message (@code{mh-compose-forward}).
4457 @c -------------------------
4458 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Get File (MH)...} menu item
4459 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Get File (MH)...}
4462 @findex mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp
4465 Add tag to include anonymous ftp reference to a file
4466 (@code{mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp}).
4467 @c -------------------------
4468 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Insertion...} menu item
4469 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Insertion...}
4472 @findex mh-compose-insertion
4475 Add tag to include a file such as an image or sound
4476 (@code{mh-compose-insertion}).
4477 @c -------------------------
4478 @cindex @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MML)} menu item
4479 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Pull in All Compositions (MML)}
4482 @findex mh-mml-to-mime
4485 Compose @sc{mime} message from MML tags (@code{mh-mml-to-mime}).
4486 @c -------------------------
4489 @findex mh-mml-unsecure-message
4492 Remove any secure message tags (@code{mh-mml-unsecure-message}).
4493 @c -------------------------
4495 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-sign
4497 Add tag to sign the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-sign}).
4498 @c -------------------------
4499 @cindex @samp{Letter > Compose Compressed tar (MH)...} menu item
4500 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Compose Compressed tar (MH)...}
4503 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar
4506 Add tag to include anonymous ftp reference to a compressed tar file
4507 (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar}).
4508 @c -------------------------
4509 @cindex @samp{Letter > Revert to Non-MIME Edit (MH)} menu item
4510 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Revert to Non-MIME Edit (MH)}
4513 @findex mh-mh-to-mime-undo
4516 Undo effects of @kbd{C-c C-e} (@code{mh-mh-to-mime-undo}).
4517 @c -------------------------
4520 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-type
4523 Add tag to refer to a remote file
4524 (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-type}).
4525 @c -------------------------
4527 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt
4529 Add tag to encrypt the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt}).
4530 @c -------------------------
4532 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt
4534 Add tag to encrypt and sign the message@*
4535 (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt}).
4536 @c -------------------------
4538 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt
4540 Add tag to encrypt and sign the message@*
4541 (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt}).
4542 @c -------------------------
4544 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-sign
4546 Add tag to sign the message (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-sign}).
4547 @c -------------------------
4548 @cindex @samp{Letter > Split Current Line} menu item
4549 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Split Current Line}
4551 @findex mh-open-line
4553 Insert a newline and leave point before it (@code{mh-open-line}).
4554 @c -------------------------
4555 @cindex @samp{Letter > Kill This Draft} menu item
4556 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Kill This Draft}
4558 @findex mh-fully-kill-draft
4560 Quit editing and delete draft message (@code{mh-fully-kill-draft}).
4561 @c -------------------------
4562 @cindex @samp{Letter > Insert Signature} menu item
4563 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Insert Signature}
4565 @findex mh-insert-signature
4567 Insert signature in message (@code{mh-insert-signature}).
4568 @c -------------------------
4570 @findex mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display
4572 Toggle display of header field at point
4573 (@code{mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display}).
4574 @c -------------------------
4575 @cindex @samp{Letter > Check Recipient} menu item
4576 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Check Recipient}
4578 @findex mh-check-whom
4580 Verify recipients, showing expansion of any aliases
4581 (@code{mh-check-whom}).
4582 @c -------------------------
4583 @cindex @samp{Letter > Yank Current Message} menu item
4584 @cindex menu item, @samp{Letter > Yank Current Message}
4586 @findex mh-yank-cur-msg
4588 Insert the current message into the draft buffer
4589 (@code{mh-yank-cur-msg}).
4590 @c -------------------------
4592 @findex mh-insert-auto-fields
4594 Insert custom fields if recipient is found in
4595 @code{mh-auto-fields-list} (@code{mh-insert-auto-fields}).
4599 @cindex @samp{mh-letter} customization group
4600 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-letter}
4602 Several options from the @samp{mh-letter} customization group are used
4603 while editing a draft.
4606 @item mh-compose-insertion
4607 Type of @sc{mime} message tags in messages (default: @samp{MML} if
4608 available; otherwise @samp{MH}).
4609 @c -------------------------
4610 @item mh-compose-skipped-header-fields
4611 List of header fields to skip over when navigating in draft (default:
4612 @code{'("From"} @code{"Organization"} @code{"References"}
4613 @code{"In-Reply-To"} @code{"X-Face"} @code{"Face"}
4614 @code{"X-Image-URL"} @code{"X-Mailer")}.
4615 @c -------------------------
4616 @item mh-compose-space-does-completion-flag
4617 On means @key{SPC} does completion in message header (default:
4619 @c -------------------------
4620 @item mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag
4621 On means delete any window displaying the message (default: @samp{off}).
4622 @c -------------------------
4623 @item mh-extract-from-attribution-verb
4624 Verb to use for attribution when a message is yanked by @kbd{C-c C-y}
4625 (default: @code{"wrote:"}).
4626 @c -------------------------
4627 @item mh-ins-buf-prefix
4628 String to put before each line of a yanked or inserted message
4629 (default: @code{"> "}).
4630 @c -------------------------
4631 @item mh-letter-complete-function
4632 Function to call when completing outside of address or folder fields
4633 (default: @code{ispell-complete-word}).
4634 @c -------------------------
4635 @item mh-letter-fill-column
4636 Fill column to use in MH-Letter mode (default: 72).
4637 @c -------------------------
4638 @item mh-mml-method-default
4639 Default method to use in security tags (default: @samp{PGP (MIME)} if
4640 support for it is available; otherwise @samp{None}).
4641 @c -------------------------
4642 @item mh-signature-file-name
4643 Source of user's signature (default: @code{"~/.signature"}).
4644 @c -------------------------
4645 @item mh-signature-separator-flag
4646 On means a signature separator should be inserted (default:
4648 @c -------------------------
4649 @item mh-x-face-file
4650 File containing X-Face or Face header field to insert in outgoing mail.
4651 (default: @code{"~/.face"}).
4652 @c -------------------------
4653 @item mh-yank-behavior
4654 Controls which part of a message is yanked by @kbd{C-c C-y} (default:
4655 @samp{Body With Attribution}).
4658 The following hooks are available.
4661 @item mail-citation-hook
4662 Hook for modifying a citation just inserted in the mail buffer
4663 (default: @code{nil}).
4664 @c -------------------------
4665 @item mh-before-send-letter-hook
4666 Hook run at the beginning of the @kbd{C-c C-c} command (default:
4668 @c -------------------------
4669 @item mh-mh-to-mime-hook
4670 Hook run on the formatted letter by @kbd{C-c C-e} (default:
4672 @c -------------------------
4673 @item mh-insert-signature-hook
4674 Hook run by @kbd{C-c C-s} after signature has been inserted (default:
4678 The following face is available.
4681 @item mh-letter-header-field
4682 Editable header field value face in draft buffers.
4685 The commands and options introduced here are explained in more
4686 detail in the following sections.
4690 * Inserting Letter::
4691 * Inserting Messages::
4694 * Adding Attachments::
4696 * Checking Recipients::
4701 @node Editing Message, Inserting Letter, Editing Drafts, Editing Drafts
4702 @section Editing the Message
4704 @cindex @samp{Bcc:} header field
4705 @cindex @samp{Cc:} header field
4706 @cindex @samp{Dcc:} header field
4707 @cindex @samp{From:} header field
4708 @cindex @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field
4709 @cindex @samp{Mail-Reply-To:} header field
4710 @cindex @samp{Reply-To:} header field
4711 @cindex @samp{Subject:} header field
4712 @cindex @samp{To:} header field
4713 @cindex editing header
4714 @cindex header field, @samp{Bcc:}
4715 @cindex header field, @samp{Cc:}
4716 @cindex header field, @samp{Dcc:}
4717 @cindex header field, @samp{From:}
4718 @cindex header field, @samp{Mail-Followup-To:}
4719 @cindex header field, @samp{Mail-Reply-To:}
4720 @cindex header field, @samp{Reply-To:}
4721 @cindex header field, @samp{Subject:}
4722 @cindex header field, @samp{To:}
4727 Because the header is part of the message, you can edit the header
4728 fields as you wish. However, several convenience commands exist to
4729 help you create and edit them. For example, the command @kbd{C-c C-f
4730 C-t} (@code{mh-to-field}; alternatively, @kbd{C-c C-f t}) moves the
4731 cursor to the @samp{To:} header field, creating it if necessary. The
4732 commands for moving to the @samp{Cc:}, @samp{Subject:}, @samp{From:},
4733 @samp{Reply-To:}, @samp{Mail-Reply-To:}, @samp{Mail-Followup-To},
4734 @samp{Bcc:}, and @samp{Dcc:} header fields are similar.
4740 One command behaves differently from the others, namely, @kbd{C-c C-f
4741 C-f} (@code{mh-to-fcc}; alternatively, @kbd{C-c C-f f}). This command
4742 will prompt you for the folder name in which to file a copy of the
4743 draft. @xref{Folder Selection}.
4745 @findex indent-relative
4746 @findex mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent
4747 @findex mh-letter-previous-header-field
4750 @vindex mh-compose-skipped-header-fields
4751 @vindex mh-letter-header-field
4753 Within the header of the message, the command@* @key{TAB}
4754 (@code{mh-letter-next-header-field-or-indent}) moves between fields
4755 that are highlighted with the face @code{mh-letter-header-field},
4756 skipping those fields listed in
4757 @code{mh-compose-skipped-header-fields}. After the last field, this
4758 command then moves point to the message body before cycling back to
4759 the first field. If point is already past the first line of the
4760 message body, then this command indents by calling
4761 @code{indent-relative} with the given prefix argument. The command
4762 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-previous-header-field}) moves
4763 backwards between the fields and cycles to the body of the message
4764 after the first field. Unlike the command @key{TAB}, it will always
4765 take point to the last field from anywhere in the body.
4767 @cindex alias completion
4770 @findex ispell-complete-word
4771 @findex mh-letter-complete
4772 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
4773 @findex mh-letter-confirm-address
4777 @vindex mh-alias-flash-on-comma
4778 @vindex mh-compose-space-does-completion-flag
4779 @vindex mh-letter-complete-function
4781 If the field contains addresses (for example, @samp{To:} or
4782 @samp{Cc:}) or folders (for example, @samp{Fcc:}) then the command
4783 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-complete}) will provide alias
4784 completion (@pxref{Aliases}). In the body of the message,
4785 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} runs @code{mh-letter-complete-function} instead,
4786 which is set to @samp{'ispell-complete-word} by default. The command
4787 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-complete}) takes a prefix argument
4788 that is passed to the @code{mh-letter-complete-function}. In addition,
4789 turn on the option @code{mh-compose-space-does-completion-flag} to use
4790 the command @key{SPC} (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}) to perform
4791 completion in the header as well; use a prefix argument to specify
4792 more than one space. Addresses are separated by a comma; when you
4793 press the comma, the command @code{mh-letter-confirm-address} flashes
4794 the alias expansion in the minibuffer if
4795 @code{mh-alias-flash-on-comma} is turned on.
4797 @c XXX Document the replacement for the inaccessible 'long argument.
4799 @findex mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display
4802 Use the command @kbd{C-c C-t}
4803 @code{mh-letter-toggle-header-field-display} to display truncated
4804 header fields. This command is a toggle so entering it again will hide
4805 the field. This command takes a prefix argument: if negative then the
4806 field is hidden, if positive then the field is displayed (for example,
4809 Be sure to leave a row of dashes or a blank line between the header
4810 and the body of the message.
4812 @vindex mh-letter-fill-column
4814 The body of the message is edited as you would edit any Emacs buffer
4815 although there are a few commands and options to assist you. You can
4816 change the fill column in MH-Letter mode with the option
4817 @code{mh-letter-fill-column}. By default, this option is 72 to allow
4818 others to quote your message without line wrapping.
4820 @cindex filling paragraphs
4821 @cindex paragraphs, filling
4822 @findex fill-paragraph
4824 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4826 You'll often include messages that were sent from user agents that
4827 haven't yet realized that paragraphs consist of more than a single
4828 line. This makes for long lines that wrap in an ugly fashion. You'll
4829 find that @kbd{M-q} (@code{fill-paragraph}) works well even on these
4830 quoted messages, even if they are nested, just as long as all of the
4831 quotes match the value of @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} (@pxref{Inserting
4832 Letter}). For example, let's assume you have the following in your
4837 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing. I'm \
4838 not sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but \
4839 it's worked okay for me so far.
4843 Running @kbd{M-q} on this paragraph produces:
4847 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing. I'm not
4848 > sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but it's
4849 > worked okay for me so far.
4853 @findex mh-open-line
4858 The command @kbd{C-c C-o} (@code{mh-open-line}) is similar to the
4859 command @kbd{C-o} (@code{open-line}) in that it inserts a newline
4860 after point. It differs in that it also inserts the right number of
4861 quoting characters and spaces so that the next line begins in the same
4862 column as it was. This is useful when breaking up paragraphs in
4863 replies. For example, if this command was used when point was after
4864 the first period in the paragraph above, the result would be this:
4868 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing.
4871 > sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but it's
4872 > worked okay for me so far.
4876 @node Inserting Letter, Inserting Messages, Editing Message, Editing Drafts
4877 @section Inserting Letter to Which You're Replying
4879 @cindex inserting messages
4880 @cindex replying to messages
4881 @cindex yanking messages
4882 @findex mh-yank-cur-msg
4884 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4886 It is often useful to insert a snippet of text from a letter that
4887 someone mailed to provide some context for your reply. The command
4888 @kbd{C-c C-y} (@code{mh-yank-cur-msg}) does this by adding an
4889 attribution, yanking a portion of text from the message to which
4890 you're replying, and inserting @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} (@samp{> })
4895 Michael W Thelen <thelenm@@stop.mail-abuse.org> wrote:
4897 > Hopefully this gives you an idea of what I'm currently doing. I'm not
4898 > sure yet whether I'm completely satisfied with my setup, but it's
4899 > worked okay for me so far.
4903 @vindex mh-extract-from-attribution-verb
4905 The attribution consists of the sender's name and email address
4906 followed by the content of the option
4907 @code{mh-extract-from-attribution-verb}. This option can be set to
4908 @samp{wrote:}, @samp{a écrit:}, and @samp{schrieb:}. You can also use
4909 the @samp{Custom String} menu item to enter your own verb.
4911 @vindex mail-citation-hook
4912 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4913 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4915 The prefix @code{"> "} is the default setting for the option
4916 @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix}. I suggest that you not modify this option
4917 since it is used by many mailers and news readers: messages are far
4918 easier to read if several included messages have all been indented by
4919 the same string. This prefix is not inserted if you use one of the
4920 supercite flavors of @code{mh-yank-behavior} or you have added a
4921 @code{mail-citation-hook} as described below.
4923 @vindex mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag
4925 You can also turn on the @code{mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag}
4926 option to delete the window containing the original message after
4927 yanking it to make more room on your screen for your reply.
4929 @cindex Emacs, packages, supercite
4930 @cindex supercite package
4932 @vindex mail-citation-hook
4933 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4935 You can control how the message to which you are replying is yanked
4936 into your reply using @code{mh-yank-behavior}. To include the entire
4937 message, including the entire header, use @samp{Body and
4938 Header}@footnote{If you'd rather have the header cleaned up, use
4939 @kbd{C-u r} instead of @kbd{r} when replying
4940 (@pxref{Replying}).}@footnote{In the past you would use this setting
4941 and set @code{mail-citation-hook} to @samp{supercite}, but this usage
4942 is now deprecated in favor of the @samp{Invoke supercite} setting.}.
4943 Use @samp{Body} to yank just the body without the header. To yank only
4944 the portion of the message following the point, set this option to
4947 Choose @samp{Invoke supercite}@footnote{@emph{Supercite} is a
4948 full-bodied, full-featured, citation package that comes standard with
4949 Emacs.} to pass the entire message and header through supercite.
4951 @vindex mh-extract-from-attribution-verb
4953 If the @samp{Body With Attribution} setting is used, then the message
4954 minus the header is yanked and a simple attribution line is added at
4955 the top using the value of the option
4956 @code{mh-extract-from-attribution-verb}. This is the default.
4959 @vindex mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag
4961 If the @samp{Invoke supercite} or @samp{Body With Attribution}
4962 settings are used, the @samp{-noformat} argument is passed to the
4963 @command{repl} program to override a @samp{-filter} or @samp{-format}
4964 argument. These settings also have @samp{Automatically} variants that
4965 perform the action automatically when you reply so that you don't need
4966 to use @kbd{C-c C-y} at all. Note that this automatic action is only
4967 performed if the show buffer matches the message being replied to.
4968 People who use the automatic variants tend to turn on the option
4969 @code{mh-delete-yanked-msg-window-flag} as well so that the show
4970 window is never displayed.
4972 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4974 If the show buffer has a region, the option @code{mh-yank-behavior} is
4975 ignored unless its value is one of @samp{Attribution} variants in
4976 which case the attribution is added to the yanked region.
4978 @findex trivial-cite
4979 @vindex mail-citation-hook
4980 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
4981 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4983 If this isn't enough, you can gain full control over the appearance of
4984 the included text by setting @code{mail-citation-hook} to a function
4985 that modifies it. This hook is ignored if the option
4986 @code{mh-yank-behavior} is set to one of the supercite flavors.
4987 Otherwise, this option controls how much of the message is passed to
4988 the hook. The function can find the citation between point and mark
4989 and it should leave point and mark around the modified citation text
4990 for the next hook function. The standard prefix
4991 @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} is not added if this hook is set.
4993 @cindex Emacs, packages, trivial-cite
4994 @cindex trivial-cite package
4995 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
4997 For example, if you use the hook function
4998 @uref{http://shasta.cs.uiuc.edu/~lrclause/tc.html,
4999 @code{trivial-cite}} (which is NOT part of Emacs), set
5000 @code{mh-yank-behavior} to @samp{Body and Header}.
5002 @node Inserting Messages, Signature, Inserting Letter, Editing Drafts
5003 @section Inserting Messages
5005 @cindex inserting messages
5006 @findex mh-insert-letter
5007 @findex mh-yank-behavior
5009 @vindex mh-ins-buf-prefix
5010 @vindex mh-invisible-header-fields-compiled
5011 @vindex mh-yank-behavior
5013 Messages can be inserted with @kbd{C-c C-i} (@code{mh-insert-letter}).
5014 This command prompts you for the folder and message number, which
5015 defaults to the current message in that folder. It then inserts the
5016 messages, indented by @code{mh-ins-buf-prefix} (@samp{> }) unless
5017 @code{mh-yank-behavior} is set to one of the supercite flavors in
5018 which case supercite is used to format the message. Certain
5019 undesirable header fields (see
5020 @code{mh-invisible-header-fields-compiled}) are removed before
5023 If given a prefix argument (like @kbd{C-u C-c C-i}), the header is
5024 left intact, the message is not indented, and @samp{> } is not
5025 inserted before each line. This command leaves the mark before the
5026 letter and point after it.
5028 @node Signature, Picture, Inserting Messages, Editing Drafts
5029 @section Inserting Your Signature
5032 @findex mh-insert-signature
5035 You can insert your signature at the current cursor location with the
5036 command @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{mh-insert-signature}).
5038 @cindex files, @file{.signature}
5039 @cindex @file{.signature}
5041 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
5043 By default, the text of your signature is taken from the file
5044 @file{~/.signature}. You can read from other sources by changing the
5045 option @code{mh-signature-file-name}. This file may contain a
5046 @dfn{vCard} in which case an attachment is added with the vCard.
5048 @findex mh-signature-separator-p
5049 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
5050 @vindex mh-signature-separator
5051 @vindex mh-signature-separator-regexp
5053 The option @code{mh-signature-file-name} may also be a symbol, in
5054 which case that function is called. You may not want a signature
5055 separator to be added for you; instead you may want to insert one
5056 yourself. Options that you may find useful to do this include
5057 @code{mh-signature-separator} (when inserting a signature separator)
5058 and @code{mh-signature-separator-regexp} (for finding said separator).
5059 The function @code{mh-signature-separator-p}, which reports @code{t}
5060 if the buffer contains a separator, may be useful as well.
5062 @cindex signature separator
5063 @vindex mh-signature-separator-flag
5065 A signature separator (@code{"-- "}) will be added if the signature
5066 block does not contain one and @code{mh-signature-separator-flag} is
5067 on. It is not recommended that you change this option since various
5068 mail user agents, including MH-E, use the separator to present the
5069 signature differently, and to suppress the signature when replying or
5070 yanking a letter into a draft.
5072 @vindex mh-insert-signature-hook
5073 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
5075 The hook @code{mh-insert-signature-hook} is run after the signature is
5076 inserted. Hook functions may access the actual name of the file or the
5077 function used to insert the signature with
5078 @code{mh-signature-file-name}.
5080 The signature can also be inserted using Identities.
5083 @node Picture, Adding Attachments, Signature, Editing Drafts
5084 @section Inserting Your Picture
5086 @cindex @file{.face}
5087 @cindex files, @file{.face}
5088 @vindex mh-x-face-file
5090 You can insert your picture in the header of your mail message so that
5091 recipients see your face in the @samp{From:} header field if their
5092 mail user agent is sophisticated enough. In MH-E, this is done by
5093 placing your image in the file named by the option
5094 @code{mh-x-face-file} which is @file{~/.face} by default.
5096 @cindex @samp{Face:} header field
5097 @cindex @samp{X-Face:} header field
5098 @cindex @samp{X-Image-URL:} header field
5099 @cindex header field, @samp{Face:}
5100 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Face:}
5101 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Image-URL:}
5103 If the file starts with either of the strings @samp{X-Face:},
5104 @samp{Face:} or @samp{X-Image-URL:} then the contents are added to the
5105 message header verbatim. Otherwise it is assumed that the file
5106 contains the value of the @samp{X-Face:} header field.
5108 @cindex @command{compface}
5109 @cindex Unix commands, @command{compface}
5111 The @samp{X-Face:} header field, which is a low-resolution, black and
5112 white image, can be generated using the
5113 @uref{ftp://ftp.cs.indiana.edu/pub/faces/compface/compface.tar.Z,
5114 @command{compface}} command. The @uref{http://www.dairiki.org/xface/,
5115 @cite{Online X-Face Converter}} is a useful resource for quick
5116 conversion of images into @samp{X-Face:} header fields.
5118 Use the @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/make-face,
5119 @command{make-face}} script to convert a JPEG image to the higher
5120 resolution, color, @samp{Face:} header field.
5122 The URL of any image can be used for the @samp{X-Image-URL:} field and
5123 no processing of the image is required.
5125 @vindex mh-x-face-file
5127 To prevent the setting of any of these header fields, either set
5128 @code{mh-x-face-file} to @code{nil}, or simply ensure that the file
5129 defined by this option doesn't exist.
5131 @xref{Viewing}, to see how these header fields are displayed in MH-E.
5133 @node Adding Attachments, Sending PGP, Picture, Editing Drafts
5134 @section Adding Attachments
5136 @cindex @command{mhbuild}
5137 @cindex @command{mhn}
5138 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhbuild}
5139 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhn}
5141 @cindex multimedia mail
5143 MH-E has the capability to create multimedia messages. It uses the
5144 @sc{mime} (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions)
5145 protocol@footnote{@sc{mime} is defined in
5146 @uref{http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2045.txt, RFC 2045}.} The
5147 @sc{mime} protocol allows you to incorporate images, sound, video,
5148 binary files, and even commands that fetch a file with @samp{ftp} when
5149 your recipient reads the message!
5153 If you were to create a multimedia message with plain MH commands, you
5154 would insert @command{mhbuild} or @command{mhn} directives (henceforth
5155 called @dfn{MH-style directives} into your draft and use the
5156 @command{mhbuild} command in nmh or @command{mhn} command in MH and
5157 GNU mailutils to expand them. MH-E works in much the same way,
5158 although it provides a handful of commands prefixed with @kbd{C-c C-m}
5159 to insert the directives so you don't need to remember the syntax of
5160 them. Remember: you can always add MH-style directives by
5161 hand@footnote{See the section
5162 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/usimim.html#SeMIMa, Sending MIME Mail} in
5165 @cindex MIME Meta Language (MML)
5167 @vindex mh-compose-insertion
5169 In addition to MH-style directives, MH-E also supports MML (@sc{mime}
5170 Meta Language) tags@footnote{
5172 @c Although the third argument should default to the
5173 @c first, makeinfo goes to the wrong Info file without it being
5174 @c different--it seems to be getting our own Composing node.
5175 @xref{Composing,,Composing with MML,emacs-mime}.
5178 See the section Composing in
5179 @uref{http://www.gnus.org/manual/emacs-mime.html, @cite{The Emacs MIME
5182 }. The option @code{mh-compose-insertion} can be used to choose
5183 between them. By default, this option is set to @samp{MML} if it is
5184 supported since it provides a lot more functionality. This option can
5185 also be set to @samp{MH} if MH-style directives are preferred.
5188 @cindex MIME, media types
5190 The MH-E @sc{mime} commands require a @dfn{media type} for each body
5191 part or attachment. For example, a PDF document is of type
5192 @samp{application/pdf} and an HTML document is of type
5193 @samp{text/html}. Some commands fill in the media type for you,
5194 whereas others require you to enter one.
5196 @cindex @command{file}
5197 @cindex @file{/etc/mime.types}
5198 @cindex files, @file{/etc/mime.types}
5199 @cindex Unix commands, @command{file}
5200 @findex mailcap-mime-types
5202 In the cases where MH-E can do so, it will determine the media type
5203 automatically. It uses the @command{file} command to do this. Failing
5204 that, the Emacs function @code{mailcap-mime-types} is used to provide
5205 a list from which to choose. This function usually reads the file
5206 @file{/etc/mime.types}.
5208 Whether the media type is chosen automatically, or you choose it from
5209 a list, use the type that seems to match best the file that you are
5210 including. In the case of binaries, the media type
5211 @samp{application/x-executable} can be useful. If you can't find an
5212 appropriate media type, use @samp{text/plain} for text messages and
5213 @samp{application/octet-stream} for everything else.
5215 @cindex content description
5216 @cindex MIME, content description
5218 You are also sometimes asked for a @dfn{content description}. This is
5219 simply an optional brief phrase, in your own words, that describes the
5220 object. If you don't care to enter a content description, just press
5221 return and none will be included; however, a reader may skip over
5222 multimedia fields unless the content description is compelling.
5224 You can also create your own @sc{mime} body parts. In the following
5225 example, I describe how you can create and edit a @samp{text/enriched}
5226 body part to liven up your plain text messages with boldface,
5227 underlining, and italics. I include an Emacs function which inserts
5232 (defvar enriched-text-types '(("b" . "bold") ("i" . "italic")
5234 ("s" . "smaller") ("B" . "bigger")
5237 "Alist of (final-character . tag) choices for add-enriched-text.
5238 Additional types can be found in RFC 1563.")
5240 (defun add-enriched-text (begin end)
5241 "Add enriched text tags around region.
5242 The tag used comes from the list enriched-text-types and is
5243 specified by the last keystroke of the command. When called from Lisp,
5244 arguments are BEGIN and END@."
5246 ;; @r{Set type to the tag indicated by the last keystroke.}
5247 (let ((type (cdr (assoc (char-to-string (logior last-input-char ?@w{`}))
5248 enriched-text-types))))
5249 (save-restriction ; @r{restores state from narrow-to-region}
5250 (narrow-to-region begin end) ; @r{narrow view to region}
5251 (goto-char (point-min)) ; @r{move to beginning of text}
5252 (insert "<" type ">") ; @r{insert beginning tag}
5253 (goto-char (point-max)) ; @r{move to end of text}
5254 (insert "</" type ">")))) ; @r{insert terminating tag}
5255 @i{Emacs function for entering enriched text}
5260 To use the function @code{add-enriched-text}, first add it to
5261 @file{~/.emacs} and create key bindings for it (@pxref{Composing}).
5263 Then, in your plain text message, set the mark with @kbd{C-@@} or
5264 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, type in the text to be highlighted, and type @kbd{C-c t
5265 b}. This adds @samp{<bold>} where you set the mark and adds
5266 @samp{</bold>} at the location of your cursor, giving you something
5267 like: @samp{You should be <bold>very</bold>}.
5269 Before sending this message, use @kbd{C-c C-m C-m}
5270 (@code{mh-mml-to-mime})@footnote{Use @kbd{C-c C-e}
5271 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime}) if you're using MH-style directives.} to add
5272 MIME header fields. Then replace @samp{text/plain} with
5273 @samp{text/enriched} in the @samp{Content-Type:} header field.
5275 You may also be interested in investigating @code{sgml-mode}.
5277 @subheading Including Files
5279 @cindex attachments, inserting
5281 @cindex MIME, images
5286 @findex mh-compose-insertion
5289 @vindex mh-compose-insertion
5291 Binaries, images, sound, and video can be inserted in your message
5292 with the command @kbd{C-c C-m C-i} (@code{mh-compose-insertion}). You
5293 are prompted for the filename containing the object, the media type if
5294 it cannot be determined automatically, and a content description. If
5295 you're using MH-style directives, you will also be prompted for
5296 additional attributes.
5298 @subheading Forwarding Multimedia Messages
5300 @findex mh-compose-forward
5304 Mail may be forwarded with @sc{mime} using the command @kbd{C-c C-m
5305 C-f} (@code{mh-compose-forward}). You are prompted for a content
5306 description, the name of the folder in which the messages to forward
5307 are located, and a range of messages, which defaults to the current
5308 message in that folder. @xref{Ranges}.
5310 @subheading Including an FTP Reference
5312 @cindex @command{ftp}
5313 @cindex MIME, @command{ftp}
5314 @cindex Unix commands, @command{ftp}
5315 @findex mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp
5319 You can have your message initiate an @command{ftp} transfer when the
5320 recipient reads the message. To do this, use the command @kbd{C-c C-m
5321 C-g} (@code{mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp}). You are prompted for the remote
5322 host and filename, the media type, and the content description.
5324 @subheading Including tar Files
5326 @cindex @command{ftp}
5327 @cindex @command{tar}
5328 @cindex MIME, @command{ftp}
5329 @cindex MIME, @command{tar}
5330 @cindex Unix commands, @command{ftp}
5331 @cindex Unix commands, @command{tar}
5332 @findex mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp
5333 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar
5338 If the remote file is a compressed tar file, you can use @kbd{C-c C-m
5339 C-t} (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-compressed-tar}). Then, in addition
5340 to retrieving the file via anonymous @emph{ftp} as per the command
5341 @kbd{C-c C-m C-g} (@code{mh-mh-compose-anon-ftp}), the file will also
5342 be uncompressed and untarred. You are prompted for the remote host and
5343 filename and the content description.
5345 @subheading Including Other External Files
5347 @findex mh-mh-compose-external-type
5351 The command @kbd{C-c C-m C-x} (@code{mh-mh-compose-external-type}) is
5352 a general utility for referencing external files. In fact, all of the
5353 other commands that insert tags to access external files call this
5354 command. You are prompted for the access type, remote host and
5355 filename, and content type. If you provide a prefix argument, you are
5356 also prompted for a content description, attributes, parameters, and a
5359 @subheading Previewing Multimedia Messages
5361 When you are finished editing a @sc{mime} message, it might look like this:
5365 3 t08/24 root received fax files on Wed Aug 24 11:00:
5366 4+t08/24 To:wohler Test<<This is a test message to get the
5372 --:%% @{+inbox@} 4 msgs (1-4) Bot L4 (MH-Folder Show)---------------
5375 Subject: Test of MIME
5377 Here is the SETI@@Home logo:
5379 <#part type="image/x-xpm" filename="~/lib/images/setiathome.xpm"
5380 disposition=inline description="SETI@@home logo">
5382 --:** @{draft@} All L8 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
5386 @i{MH-E @sc{mime} draft}
5388 @findex mh-mml-to-mime
5392 Typically, you send a message with attachments just like any other
5393 message (@pxref{Sending Message}).
5395 @findex mh-mml-to-mime
5398 However, you may take a sneak preview of the @sc{mime} encoding if you
5399 wish by running the command @kbd{C-c C-m C-m} (@code{mh-mml-to-mime}).
5400 The following screen shows the @sc{mime} encoding specified by the
5401 tags. You can see why mail user agents are usually built to hide these
5402 details from the user.
5408 Subject: Test of MIME
5409 X-Mailer: MH-E 8.0; nmh 1.1; GNU Emacs 22.1
5411 Content-Type: multipart/mixed; boundary="=-=-="
5415 Here is the SETI@@Home logo:
5419 Content-Type: image/x-xpm
5420 Content-Disposition: inline; filename=setiathome.xpm
5421 Content-Transfer-Encoding: base64
5422 Content-Description: SETI@@home logo
5424 LyogWFBNICovCnN0YXRpYyBjaGFyICogc2V0aWF0aG9tZV94cG1bXSA9IHsKIjQ1IDQ1IDc2N
5425 --:-- @{draft@} Top L1 (MH-Letter)----------------------------------
5429 @i{MH-E @sc{mime} draft ready to send}
5431 @cindex undo effects of mh-mml-to-mime
5433 This action can be undone by running @kbd{C-_} (@code{undo}).
5435 @cindex @command{mhbuild}
5436 @cindex @command{mhn}
5437 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhbuild}
5438 @cindex MH commands, @command{mhn}
5439 @cindex undo effects of mh-mh-to-mime
5440 @findex mh-mh-to-mime
5441 @findex mh-mh-to-mime-undo
5447 If you're using MH-style directives, use @kbd{C-c C-e}
5448 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime}) instead of @kbd{C-c C-m C-m}. This runs the
5449 command @command{mhbuild} (@command{mhn}) on the message which expands
5450 the tags@footnote{See the section
5451 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/usimim.html#SeMIMa, Sending MIME Mail} in
5452 the MH book.}. This action can be undone by running @kbd{C-c C-m C-u}
5453 (@code{mh-mh-to-mime-undo}), which works by reverting to a backup
5454 file. You are prompted to confirm this action, but you can avoid the
5455 confirmation by adding an argument (for example, @kbd{C-u C-c C-m
5459 @vindex mh-mh-to-mime-args
5461 If you wish to pass additional arguments to @command{mhbuild}
5462 (@command{mhn}) to affect how it builds your message, use the option
5463 @code{mh-mh-to-mime-args}. For example, you can build a consistency
5464 check into the message by setting @code{mh-mh-to-mime-args} to
5465 @samp{-check}. The recipient of your message can then run
5466 @samp{mhbuild -check} on the message---@command{mhbuild}
5467 (@command{mhn}) will complain if the message has been corrupted on the
5468 way. The command @kbd{C-c C-e} only consults this option when given a
5469 prefix argument (as in @kbd{C-u C-c C-e}).
5472 @vindex mh-mh-to-mime-hook
5474 The hook @code{mh-mh-to-mime-hook} is called after the message has
5475 been formatted by @kbd{C-c C-e}.
5477 @node Sending PGP, Checking Recipients, Adding Attachments, Editing Drafts
5478 @section Signing and Encrypting Messages
5480 @cindex signing messages
5481 @cindex encrypting messages
5484 MH-E can sign and encrypt messages as defined in
5485 @uref{http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3156.txt, RFC 3156}. If you
5486 should choose to sign or encrypt your message, use one of the
5487 following commands to do so any time before sending your message.
5489 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt
5490 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-sign
5491 @findex mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt
5499 The command @kbd{C-c C-m C-s} (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-sign})
5500 inserts the following tag:
5503 <#secure method=pgpmime mode=sign>
5506 This is used to sign your message digitally. Likewise, the command
5507 @kbd{C-c C-m C-e} (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-encrypt}) inserts the
5511 <#secure method=pgpmime mode=encrypt>
5514 This is used to encrypt your message. Finally, the command @kbd{C-c
5515 C-m s e} (@code{mh-mml-secure-message-signencrypt}) inserts the
5519 <#secure method=pgpmime mode=signencrypt>
5522 @findex mh-mml-unsecure-message
5525 @vindex mh-mml-method-default
5527 This is used to sign and encrypt your message. In each of these cases,
5528 a proper multipart message is created for you when you send the
5529 message. Use the command @kbd{C-c C-m C-n}
5530 (@code{mh-mml-unsecure-message}) to remove these tags. Use a prefix
5531 argument (as in @kbd{C-u C-c C-m s e}) to be prompted for one of the
5532 possible security methods (see @code{mh-mml-method-default}).
5534 @vindex mh-mml-method-default
5536 The option @code{mh-mml-method-default} is used to select between a
5537 variety of mail security mechanisms. The default is @samp{PGP (MIME)}
5538 if it is supported; otherwise, the default is @samp{None}. Other
5539 mechanisms include vanilla @samp{PGP} and @samp{S/MIME}.
5541 @cindex @samp{pgg} customization group
5543 @cindex customization group, @samp{pgg}
5545 The @samp{pgg} customization group may have some settings which may
5548 See @cite{The PGG Manual}.
5551 @xref{Top, , The PGG Manual, pgg, The PGG Manual}.
5555 @uref{http://www.dk.xemacs.org/Documentation/packages/html/pgg.html,
5556 @cite{The PGG Manual}}.
5559 @cindex header field, @samp{Fcc:}
5560 @cindex @samp{Fcc:} header field
5561 @vindex pgg-encrypt-for-me
5563 In particular, I turn on the option @code{pgg-encrypt-for-me} so that
5564 all messages I encrypt are encrypted with my public key as well. If
5565 you keep a copy of all of your outgoing mail with a @samp{Fcc:} header
5566 field, this setting is vital so that you can read the mail you write!
5568 @node Checking Recipients, Sending Message, Sending PGP, Editing Drafts
5569 @section Checking Recipients
5571 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
5572 @cindex @command{whom}
5573 @cindex MH commands, @command{whom}
5574 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
5575 @cindex checking recipients
5576 @cindex recipients, checking
5577 @findex mh-check-whom
5580 The command @kbd{C-c C-w} (@code{mh-check-whom}) expands aliases so
5581 you can check the actual address(es) in the alias. A new buffer named
5582 @samp{*MH-E Recipients*} is created with the output of @command{whom}
5583 (@pxref{Miscellaneous})@footnote{See the section
5584 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/senove.html#WhaPro, What now? -- and the
5585 whatnow Program} in the MH book.}.
5587 @node Sending Message, Killing Draft, Checking Recipients, Editing Drafts
5588 @section Sending a Message
5590 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
5591 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
5592 @cindex sending mail
5593 @findex mh-send-letter
5596 When you are all through editing a message, you send it with the
5597 command @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{mh-send-letter}). You can give a prefix
5598 argument (as in @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}) to monitor the first stage of the
5599 delivery; this output can be found in a buffer called @samp{*MH-E Mail
5600 Delivery*} (@pxref{Miscellaneous}).
5602 @cindex sending mail
5604 @findex ispell-message
5606 @vindex mh-before-send-letter-hook
5608 The hook @code{mh-before-send-letter-hook} is run at the beginning of
5609 the command @kbd{C-c C-c}. For example, if you want to check your
5610 spelling in your message before sending, add the function
5611 @code{ispell-message}.
5613 @cindex @command{send}
5614 @cindex MH commands, @command{send}
5615 @vindex mh-send-prog
5617 In case the MH @command{send} program@footnote{See the section
5618 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/sensen.html, Sending Some Mail: comp send}
5619 in the MH book.} is installed under a different name, use
5620 @code{mh-send-prog} to tell MH-E the name.
5622 @node Killing Draft, , Sending Message, Editing Drafts
5623 @section Killing the Draft
5625 @cindex killing draft
5627 @findex mh-fully-kill-draft
5631 If for some reason you are not happy with the draft, you can use the
5632 command @kbd{C-c C-q} (@code{mh-fully-kill-draft}) to kill the draft
5633 buffer and delete the draft message. Use the command @kbd{C-x k}
5634 (@code{kill-buffer}) if you don't want to delete the draft message.
5636 @node Aliases, Identities, Editing Drafts, Top
5641 MH aliases are used in the same way in MH-E as they are in MH. Any
5642 alias listed as a recipient will be expanded when the message is sent.
5643 This chapter discusses other things you can do with aliases in MH-E.
5645 @cindex MH-Letter mode
5646 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
5648 The following commands are available in MH-Letter mode with the
5649 exception of @code{mh-alias-reload} which can be called from anywhere.
5653 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
5655 Perform completion or insert space (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}).
5656 @c -------------------------
5658 @findex mh-letter-complete
5660 Perform completion on header field or word preceding point
5661 (@code{mh-letter-complete}).
5662 @c -------------------------
5663 @findex mh-alias-apropos
5664 @item mh-alias-apropos
5665 Show all aliases or addresses that match a regular expression.
5666 @c -------------------------
5667 @findex mh-alias-grab-from-field
5668 @item mh-alias-grab-from-field
5669 Add alias for the sender of the current message
5670 @c -------------------------
5671 @findex mh-alias-reload
5672 @item mh-alias-reload
5676 @cindex @samp{mh-alias} customization group
5677 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-alias}
5679 The @samp{mh-alias} customization group contains options associated
5683 @item mh-alias-completion-ignore-case-flag
5684 On means don't consider case significant in MH alias completion
5685 (default: @samp{on}).
5686 @c -------------------------
5687 @item mh-alias-expand-aliases-flag
5688 On means to expand aliases entered in the minibuffer (default:
5690 @c -------------------------
5691 @item mh-alias-flash-on-comma
5692 Specify whether to flash address or warn on translation (default: @samp{Flash
5693 but Don't Warn If No Alias}).
5694 @c -------------------------
5695 @item mh-alias-insert-file
5696 Filename used to store a new MH-E alias (default: @samp{Use Aliasfile
5697 Profile Component}).
5698 @c -------------------------
5699 @item mh-alias-insertion-location
5700 Specifies where new aliases are entered in alias files (default:
5701 @samp{Alphabetical}).
5702 @c -------------------------
5703 @item mh-alias-local-users
5704 If @samp{on}, local users are added to alias completion (default:
5706 @c -------------------------
5707 @item mh-alias-local-users-prefix
5708 String prefixed to the real names of users from the password file
5709 (default: @code{"local."}.
5710 @c -------------------------
5711 @item mh-alias-passwd-gecos-comma-separator-flag
5712 On means the GECOS field in the password file uses a comma separator
5713 (default: @samp{on}).
5716 The following hook is available.
5719 @item mh-alias-reloaded-hook
5720 Hook run by @code{mh-alias-reload} after loading aliases (default:
5724 @subheading Adding Addresses to Draft
5726 You can use aliases when you are adding recipients to a message.
5728 @findex minibuffer-complete
5730 @vindex mh-alias-expand-aliases-flag
5731 @vindex mh-compose-prompt-flag
5733 In order to use minibuffer prompting for recipients and the subject
5734 line in the minibuffer, turn on the option
5735 @code{mh-compose-prompt-flag} (@pxref{Composing}), and use the
5736 @key{TAB} (@code{minibuffer-complete}) command to complete aliases
5737 (and optionally local logins) when prompted for the recipients. Turn
5738 on the option @code{mh-alias-expand-aliases-flag} if you want these
5739 aliases to be expanded to their respective addresses in the draft.
5741 @findex mh-letter-complete
5742 @findex mh-letter-complete-or-space
5746 Otherwise, you can complete aliases in the header of the draft with
5747 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{mh-letter-complete}) or @key{SPC}
5748 (@code{mh-letter-complete-or-space}).
5750 @vindex mh-alias-completion-ignore-case-flag
5752 As MH ignores case in the aliases, so too does MH-E. However, you may
5753 turn off the option @code{mh-alias-completion-ignore-case-flag} to
5754 make case significant which can be used to segregate completion of
5755 your aliases. You might use uppercase for mailing lists and lowercase
5756 for people. For example, you might have:
5759 mark.baushke: Mark Baushke <mdb@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
5760 MH-E: MH-E Mailing List <mh-e-devel@@stop.mail-abuse.org>
5763 When this option is turned off, if you were to type @kbd{M} in the
5764 @samp{To:} field and then @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}, then you'd get the list;
5765 if you started with @kbd{m} and then entered @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}, then
5766 you'd get Mark's address. Note that this option affects completion
5767 only. If you were to enter @kbd{Mark.Baushke}, it would still be
5768 identified with your @samp{mark.baushke} alias.
5770 @findex mh-alias-minibuffer-confirm-address
5771 @findex mh-letter-confirm-address
5772 @vindex mh-alias-flash-on-comma
5773 @vindex mh-compose-prompt-flag
5775 To verify that the alias you've entered is valid, the alias will be
5776 displayed in the minibuffer when you type a comma
5777 (@code{mh-letter-confirm-address} or
5778 @code{mh-alias-minibuffer-confirm-address} if the option
5779 @code{mh-compose-prompt-flag} is turned on). @xref{Composing}. This
5780 behavior can be controlled with the option
5781 @code{mh-alias-flash-on-comma} which provides three choices:
5782 @samp{Flash but Don't Warn If No Alias}, @samp{Flash and Warn If No
5783 Alias}, and @samp{Don't Flash Nor Warn If No Alias}.
5785 For another way to verify the alias expansion, see @ref{Checking
5788 @subheading Loading Aliases
5790 @cindex @command{ali}
5791 @cindex @file{/etc/nmh/MailAliases}
5792 @cindex @samp{Aliasfile:} MH profile component
5793 @cindex MH commands, @command{ali}
5794 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Aliasfile:}
5795 @cindex files, @file{/etc/nmh/MailAliases}
5797 MH-E loads aliases for completion and folder name hints from various
5798 places. It uses the MH command @command{ali}@footnote{See the section
5799 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/mh.html, MH Aliases} in the MH book.} to
5800 read aliases from the files listed in the profile component
5801 @samp{Aliasfile:} as well as system-wide aliases (for example,
5802 @file{/etc/nmh/MailAliases}).
5804 @cindex @file{/etc/passwd}
5805 @cindex files, @file{/etc/passwd}
5807 In addition, aliases are created from @file{/etc/passwd} entries with
5808 a user ID larger than a magical number, typically 200. This can be a
5809 handy tool on a machine where you and co-workers exchange messages.
5810 These aliases have the form @samp{local.@var{first.last}} if a real
5811 name is present in the password file. Otherwise, the alias will have
5812 the form @samp{local.@var{login}}.
5814 @vindex mh-alias-local-users-prefix
5816 The prefix @samp{local.} can be modified via the option
5817 @code{mh-alias-local-users-prefix}. This option can also be set to
5820 For example, consider the following password file entry:
5823 psg:x:1000:1000:Peter S Galbraith,,,:/home/psg:/bin/tcsh
5826 @vindex mh-alias-local-users-prefix
5828 The following settings of option @code{mh-alias-local-users-prefix}
5829 will produce the associated aliases:
5833 local.peter.galbraith
5834 @c -------------------------
5837 @c -------------------------
5842 @vindex mh-alias-passwd-gecos-comma-separator-flag
5844 In the example above, commas are used to separate different values
5845 within the so-called GECOS field. This is a fairly common usage.
5846 However, in the rare case that the GECOS field in your password file
5847 is not separated by commas and whose contents may contain commas, you
5848 can turn the option @code{mh-alias-passwd-gecos-comma-separator-flag}
5851 @cindex NIS, obtaining local aliases from
5852 @cindex @samp{ypcat passwd}
5853 @vindex mh-alias-local-users
5855 If you're on a system with thousands of users you don't know, and the
5856 loading of local aliases slows MH-E down noticeably, then the local
5857 alias feature can be disabled by turning off the option
5858 @code{mh-alias-local-users}. This option also takes a string which is
5859 executed to generate the password file. For example, use @samp{ypcat
5860 passwd} to obtain the NIS password file.
5862 @findex mh-alias-reload
5863 @kindex M-x mh-alias-reload
5864 @vindex mh-alias-reloaded-hook
5866 Since aliases are updated frequently, MH-E reloads aliases
5867 automatically whenever an alias lookup occurs if an alias source has
5868 changed. However, you can reload your aliases manually by calling the
5869 command @kbd{M-x mh-alias-reload} directly. This command runs
5870 @code{mh-alias-reloaded-hook} after the aliases have been loaded.
5872 @subheading Adding Aliases
5874 In the past, you have manually added aliases to your alias file(s)
5875 listed in your @samp{Aliasfile:} profile component. MH-E provides
5876 other methods for maintaining your alias file(s).
5878 @findex mh-alias-add-alias
5879 @kindex M-x mh-alias-add-alias
5881 You can use the @kbd{M-x mh-alias-add-alias} command which will prompt
5882 you for the alias and address that you would like to add. If the alias
5883 exists already, you will have the choice of inserting the new alias
5884 before or after the old alias. In the former case, this alias will be
5885 used when sending mail to this alias. In the latter case, the alias
5886 serves as an additional folder name hint when filing messages
5887 (@pxref{Folder Selection}).
5889 Earlier, the alias prefix @samp{local} was presented. You can use
5890 other prefixes to organize your aliases or disambiguate entries. You
5891 might use prefixes for locales, jobs, or activities. For example, I
5897 attensity.don.mitchell: Don Mitchell <dmitchell@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5898 isharp.don.mitchell: Don Mitchell <donaldsmitchell@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5901 diving.ken.mayer: Ken Mayer <kmayer@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5902 sailing.mike.maloney: Mike Maloney <mmaloney@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5905 ariane.kolkmann: Ariane Kolkmann <ArianeKolkmann@@stop.mail-abuse.com>
5910 Using prefixes instead of postfixes helps you explore aliases during
5911 completion. If you forget the name of an old dive buddy, you can enter
5912 @samp{div} and then @key{SPC} to get a listing of all your dive buddies.
5914 @kindex M-x mh-alias-add-address-under-point
5915 @kindex M-x mh-alias-grab-from-field
5917 An alias for the sender of the current message is added automatically
5918 by clicking on the @samp{Grab From alias} tool bar button or by running
5919 the @kbd{M-x mh-alias-grab-from-field} command. Aliases for other
5920 recipients of the current message are added by placing your cursor
5921 over the desired recipient and giving the @kbd{M-x
5922 mh-alias-add-address-under-point} command.
5924 @vindex mh-alias-insert-file
5925 @vindex mh-alias-insertion-location
5927 The options @code{mh-alias-insert-file} and
5928 @code{mh-alias-insertion-location} controls how and where these aliases
5931 @vindex mh-alias-insert-file
5933 The default setting of option @code{mh-alias-insert-file} is @samp{Use
5934 Aliasfile Profile Component}. This option can also hold the name of a
5935 file or a list a file names. If this option is set to a list of file
5936 names, or the @samp{Aliasfile:} profile component contains more than
5937 one file name, MH-E will prompt for one of them.
5939 @vindex mh-alias-insertion-location
5941 The option @code{mh-alias-insertion-location} is set to
5942 @samp{Alphabetical} by default. If you organize your alias file in
5943 other ways, then the settings @samp{Top} and @samp{Bottom} might be
5946 @subheading Querying Aliases
5948 @cindex regular expressions, @code{mh-alias-apropos}
5949 @findex mh-alias-apropos
5950 @kindex M-x mh-alias-apropos
5952 If you can't quite remember an alias, you can use @kbd{M-x
5953 mh-alias-apropos} to show all aliases or addresses that match a
5956 (@pxref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The
5961 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Regexps.html,
5962 Syntax of Regular Expressions} in
5963 @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}).
5966 @node Identities, Speedbar, Aliases, Top
5970 @cindex multiple personalities
5972 MH-E supports the concept of multiple personalities or identities.
5973 This means that you can easily have a different header and signature
5974 at home and at work.
5976 @cindex @samp{Identity} menu
5977 @cindex menu, @samp{Identity}
5979 A couple of commands are used to insert identities in MH-Letter mode
5980 which are also found in the @samp{Identity} menu.
5984 @findex mh-insert-identity
5986 Insert fields specified by given identity (@code{mh-insert-identity}).
5987 @c -------------------------
5988 @cindex @samp{Identity > Insert Auto Fields} menu item
5989 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Insert Auto Fields}
5991 @findex mh-insert-auto-fields
5993 Insert custom fields if recipient found in @code{mh-auto-fields-list}
5994 (@code{mh-insert-auto-fields}).
5997 @cindex @samp{mh-identity} customization group
5998 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-identity}
6000 The @samp{mh-identity} customization group contains the following
6004 @item mh-auto-fields-list
6005 List of recipients for which header lines are automatically inserted
6006 (default: @code{nil}).
6007 @c -------------------------
6008 @item mh-auto-fields-prompt-flag
6009 On means to prompt before sending if fields inserted (default:
6011 @c -------------------------
6012 @item mh-identity-default
6013 Default identity to use when @code{mh-letter-mode} is called (default:
6015 @c -------------------------
6016 @item mh-identity-handlers
6017 Handler functions for fields in @code{mh-identity-list}.
6018 @c -------------------------
6019 @item mh-identity-list
6020 List of identities (default: @code{nil}).
6023 Some of the common header fields that people change depending on the
6024 context are the @samp{From:} and @samp{Organization:} fields, as well
6027 @vindex mh-identity-list
6029 This is done by customizing the option @code{mh-identity-list}. In the
6030 customization buffer for this option, click on the @samp{INS} button
6031 and enter a label such as @samp{Home} or @samp{Work}. Then click on
6032 the @samp{INS} button with the label @samp{Add at least one item
6033 below}. The @samp{Value Menu} has the following menu items:
6036 @cindex header field, @samp{From:}
6037 @cindex @samp{From:} header field
6039 Specify an alternate @samp{From:} header field. You must include a
6040 valid email address. A standard format is @samp{First Last
6041 <login@@host.domain>}. If you use an initial with a period, then you
6042 must quote your name as in @samp{"First I. Last"
6043 <login@@host.domain>}.
6044 @c -------------------------
6045 @cindex header field, @samp{Organization:}
6046 @cindex @samp{Organization:} header field
6047 @item Organization Field
6048 People usually list the name of the company where they work here.
6049 @c -------------------------
6051 Set any arbitrary header field and value here. Unless the header field
6052 is a standard one, precede the name of your field's label with
6053 @samp{X-}, as in @samp{X-Fruit-of-the-Day:}.
6054 @c -------------------------
6055 @item Attribution Verb
6056 This value overrides the setting of
6057 @code{mh-extract-from-attribution-verb}. @xref{Inserting Letter}.
6058 @c -------------------------
6060 @vindex mh-signature-file-name
6062 Set your signature with this item. You can specify the contents of
6063 @code{mh-signature-file-name}, a file, or a function.
6065 @c -------------------------
6067 Specify a different key to sign or encrypt messages.
6070 @cindex Identity menu
6071 @cindex menu, Identity
6072 @findex mh-insert-identity
6075 You can select the identities you have added via the menu called
6076 @samp{Identity} in the MH-Letter buffer. You can also use @kbd{C-c
6077 C-d} (@code{mh-insert-identity}). To clear the fields and signature
6078 added by the identity, select the @samp{None} identity.
6080 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Customize Identities}
6081 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Save as Default}
6082 @cindex menu item, @samp{Identity > Set Default for Session}
6083 @cindex @samp{Identity > Customize Identities} menu item
6084 @cindex @samp{Identity > Save as Default} menu item
6085 @cindex @samp{Identity > Set Default for Session} menu item
6086 @vindex mh-identity-default
6088 The @samp{Identity} menu contains two other items to save you from
6089 having to set the identity on every message. The menu item @samp{Set
6090 Default for Session} can be used to set the default identity to the
6091 current identity until you exit Emacs. The menu item @samp{Save as
6092 Default} sets the option @code{mh-identity-default} to the current
6093 identity setting. You can also customize the option
6094 @code{mh-identity-default} in the usual fashion. If you find that you
6095 need to add another identity, the menu item @samp{Customize
6096 Identities} is available for your convenience.
6098 @cindex regular expressions, @code{mh-auto-fields-list}
6099 @vindex mh-auto-fields-list
6101 The option @code{mh-auto-fields-list} can also be used to set the
6102 identity depending on the recipient to provide even more control. To
6103 customize @code{mh-auto-fields-list}, click on the @samp{INS} button
6104 and enter a regular expression for the recipient's address
6106 (@pxref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The
6111 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Regexps.html,
6112 Syntax of Regular Expressions} in
6113 @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6115 Click on the @samp{INS} button with the @samp{Add at least one item
6116 below} label. The @samp{Value Menu} contains the following menu items:
6120 Select an identity from those configured in @code{mh-identity-list}.
6121 All of the information for that identity will be added if the
6123 @c -------------------------
6124 @cindex @samp{Fcc:} header field
6125 @cindex header field, @samp{Fcc:}
6127 Insert an @samp{Fcc:} header field with the folder you provide. When
6128 you send the message, MH will put a copy of your message in this
6130 @c -------------------------
6131 @cindex @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field
6132 @cindex header field, @samp{Mail-Followup-To:}
6133 @item Mail-Followup-To Field
6134 Insert an @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field with the recipients
6135 you provide. If the recipient's mail user agent supports this header
6136 field@footnote{@samp{Mail-Followup-To:} is supported by nmh.}, then
6137 their replies will go to the addresses listed. This is useful if their
6138 replies go both to the list and to you and you don't have a mechanism
6139 to suppress duplicates. If you reply to someone not on the list, you
6140 must either remove the @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} field, or ensure the
6141 recipient is also listed there so that he receives replies to your
6143 @c -------------------------
6145 Other header fields may be added using this menu item.
6148 @findex mh-insert-auto-fields
6150 @vindex mh-auto-fields-prompt-flag
6152 These fields can only be added after the recipient is known. Because
6153 you can continue to add recipients as you edit the draft, MH-E waits
6154 until the message is sent to perform the auto-insertions. This seems
6155 strange at first, but you'll get used to it. There are two ways to
6156 help you feel that the desired fields are added. The first is the
6157 action when the message is sent: if any fields are added
6158 automatically, you are given a chance to see and to confirm these
6159 fields before the message is actually sent. You can do away with this
6160 confirmation by turning off the option
6161 @code{mh-auto-fields-prompt-flag}. The second method is manual: once
6162 the header contains one or more recipients, you may run the command
6163 @kbd{C-c M-d} (@code{mh-insert-auto-fields}) or choose the
6164 @samp{Identity -> Insert Auto Fields} menu item to insert these fields
6165 manually. However, if you use this command, the automatic insertion
6166 when the message is sent is disabled.
6168 @vindex mh-auto-fields-list
6169 @vindex mh-identity-list
6171 You should avoid using the same header field in
6172 @code{mh-auto-fields-list} and @code{mh-identity-list} definitions
6173 that may apply to the same message as the result is undefined.
6175 @vindex mh-identity-handlers
6176 @vindex mh-identity-list
6178 The option @code{mh-identity-handlers} is used to change the way that
6179 fields, signatures, and attributions in @code{mh-identity-list} are
6180 added. To customize @code{mh-identity-handlers}, replace the name of
6181 an existing handler function associated with the field you want to
6182 change with the name of a function you have written. You can also
6183 click on an @samp{INS} button and insert a field of your choice and
6184 the name of the function you have written to handle it.
6186 @vindex mh-identity-list
6188 The @samp{Field} field can be any field that you've used in your
6189 @code{mh-identity-list}. The special fields @samp{:attribution-verb},
6190 @samp{:signature}, or @samp{:pgg-default-user-id} are used for the
6191 @code{mh-identity-list} choices @samp{Attribution Verb},
6192 @samp{Signature}, and @samp{GPG Key ID} respectively.
6194 The handler associated with the @samp{:default} field is used when no
6195 other field matches.
6197 The handler functions are passed two or three arguments: the field
6198 itself (for example, @samp{From}), or one of the special fields (for
6199 example, @samp{:signature}), and the action @samp{'remove} or
6200 @samp{'add}. If the action is @samp{'add}, an additional argument
6201 containing the value for the field is given.
6203 @node Speedbar, Menu Bar, Identities, Top
6204 @chapter The Speedbar
6206 @cindex folder navigation
6208 @findex mh-visit-folder
6210 @kindex M-x speedbar
6213 You can also use the speedbar
6215 (@pxref{Speedbar, , Speedbar Frames, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual},)
6219 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Speedbar.html,
6220 Speedbar Frames} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual})
6222 to view your folders. To bring up the speedbar, run @kbd{M-x speedbar
6223 @key{RET}}. You will see a new frame appear with all of your MH
6224 folders. Folders with unseen messages appear in boldface. Click on a
6225 folder name with @kbd{Mouse-2} to visit that folder in a similar
6226 fashion to the command @kbd{F v} (@code{mh-visit-folder})
6227 (@pxref{Folders}). Click on the @samp{+} icon to expand and view the
6228 sub-folders of that folder.
6230 The speedbar can be manipulated with the keyboard as well. Use the
6231 Emacs navigational keys (like the arrow keys, or @kbd{C-n}) to move
6232 the cursor over the desired folder and then use the shortcuts for the
6233 menu items listed in the table below.
6236 @findex mh-speed-view
6237 @item Visit Folder (@key{RET})
6238 Visits the selected folder just as if you had used @kbd{F v}
6239 (@code{mh-speed-view}).
6240 @c -------------------------
6241 @findex mh-speed-expand-folder
6242 @item Expand Nested Folders (@kbd{+})
6243 Expands the selected folder in the speedbar, exposing the children
6244 folders inside it (@code{mh-speed-expand-folder}).
6245 @c -------------------------
6246 @findex mh-speed-contract-folder
6247 @item Contract Nested Folders (@kbd{-})
6248 Contracts or collapses the selected folder in the speedbar, hiding the
6249 children folders inside it (@code{mh-speed-contract-folder}).
6250 @c -------------------------
6251 @findex mh-speed-refresh
6252 @item Refresh Speedbar (@kbd{r})
6253 Regenerates the list of folders in the speedbar. Run this command if
6254 you've added or deleted a folder, or want to update the unseen message
6255 count before the next automatic update (@code{mh-speed-refresh}).
6258 @findex delete-frame
6262 You can click on @kbd{Mouse-3} to bring up a context menu that
6263 contains these items. Dismiss the speedbar with @kbd{C-x 5 0}
6264 (@code{delete-frame}).
6266 @cindex @command{flists}
6267 @cindex MH commands, @command{flists}
6268 @cindex @samp{mh-speedbar} customization group
6269 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-speedbar}
6271 The MH-E speedbar uses the MH command @command{flists}@footnote{See
6272 the section @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/morseq.html#flist, Searching for
6273 Sequences with flist} in the MH book.} to generate the list of
6274 folders. The @samp{mh-speedbar} customization group contains the
6275 following option which controls how often the speedbar calls
6279 @item mh-speed-update-interval
6280 Time between speedbar updates in seconds (default: 60). Set to 0 to
6281 disable automatic update.
6284 You can modify the appearance of the folders in the speedbar by
6285 customizing the following faces.
6288 @item mh-speedbar-folder
6290 @c -------------------------
6291 @item mh-speedbar-folder-with-unseen-messages
6292 Folder face when folder contains unread messages.
6293 @c -------------------------
6294 @item mh-speedbar-selected-folder
6295 Selected folder face.
6296 @c -------------------------
6297 @item mh-speedbar-selected-folder-with-unseen-messages
6298 Selected folder face when folder contains unread messages.
6301 @node Menu Bar, Tool Bar, Speedbar, Top
6302 @chapter The Menu Bar
6304 @cindex @samp{Folder} menu
6305 @cindex @samp{Identity} menu
6306 @cindex @samp{Letter} menu
6307 @cindex @samp{Message} menu
6308 @cindex @samp{Search} menu
6309 @cindex @samp{Sequence} menu
6311 @cindex Identity menu
6313 @cindex MH-Folder mode
6314 @cindex MH-Letter mode
6315 @cindex MH-Search mode
6316 @cindex Message menu
6318 @cindex Sequence menu
6320 @cindex menu, Folder
6321 @cindex menu, Identity
6322 @cindex menu, Letter
6323 @cindex menu, Message
6324 @cindex menu, Search
6325 @cindex menu, Sequence
6326 @cindex menu, @samp{Folder}
6327 @cindex menu, @samp{Identity}
6328 @cindex menu, @samp{Letter}
6329 @cindex menu, @samp{Message}
6330 @cindex menu, @samp{Search}
6331 @cindex menu, @samp{Sequence}
6332 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
6333 @cindex modes, MH-Letter
6334 @cindex modes, MH-Search
6336 For those of you who prefer to mouse and menu instead of using the
6337 meta-coke-bottle-bucky keys, MH-E provides menu items for most of its
6338 functions. The MH-Folder buffer adds the @samp{Folder},
6339 @samp{Message}, and @samp{Sequence} menus. The MH-Letter buffer adds
6340 the @samp{Identity} and @samp{Letter} menus. The MH-Search buffer adds
6341 the @samp{Search} menu. There's no need to list the actual items here,
6342 as you can more easily see them for yourself, and the functions are
6343 already described elsewhere in this manual.
6345 For a description of the menu bar, please
6347 @xref{Menu Bar, , The Menu Bar, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6351 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Menu-Bar.html,
6352 The Menu Bar} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6355 The Emacs manual describes how to get online help for a particular
6356 menu item. You can also look up a menu item in the index of this
6357 manual in two ways: all of the menu items are listed alphabetically,
6358 and you can also browse all of the items under the index entry
6361 @node Tool Bar, Searching, Menu Bar, Top
6362 @chapter The Tool Bar
6366 Emacs also provides a graphical tool bar. For a description of the
6369 @xref{Tool Bars, , Tool Bars, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6373 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Tool-Bars.html,
6374 Tool Bars} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
6377 @cindex @samp{mh-tool-bar} customization group
6378 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-tool-bar}
6380 MH-E adds several icons to this tool bar; you can modify the MH-E
6381 aspects of the tool bar via the @samp{mh-tool-bar} customization group.
6384 @item mh-tool-bar-folder-buttons
6385 List of buttons to include in MH-Folder tool bar (default: a checklist
6386 too long to list here).
6387 @c -------------------------
6388 @item mh-tool-bar-letter-buttons
6389 List of buttons to include in MH-Letter tool bar (default: a checklist
6390 too long to list here).
6391 @c -------------------------
6392 @item mh-tool-bar-search-function
6393 Function called by the tool bar search button (default:
6395 @c -------------------------
6396 @item mh-xemacs-tool-bar-position
6397 Tool bar location (default: @samp{Same As Default Tool Bar}).
6398 @c -------------------------
6399 @item mh-xemacs-use-tool-bar-flag
6400 If @samp{on}, use tool bar (default: @samp{on}, if supported).
6403 In GNU Emacs, icons for some of MH-E's functions are added to the tool
6404 bar. In XEmacs, you have the opportunity to create a separate tool bar for
6407 @vindex mh-tool-bar-folder-buttons
6408 @vindex mh-tool-bar-letter-buttons
6410 In either case, you can select which of these functions you'd like to
6411 see by customizing the options @code{mh-tool-bar-folder-buttons} and
6412 @code{mh-tool-bar-letter-buttons}. As you probably guessed, the former
6413 customizes the tool bar in MH-Folder mode and the latter in MH-Letter
6414 mode. Both of these options present you with a list of functions;
6415 check the functions whose icons you want to see and clear the check
6416 boxes for those you don't.
6419 @vindex mh-tool-bar-search-function
6421 The function associated with the searching icon can be set via the
6422 option @code{mh-tool-bar-search-function}. By default, this is set to
6423 @code{mh-search}. @xref{Searching}. You can also choose @samp{Other
6424 Function} from the @samp{Value Menu} and enter a function of your own
6427 @vindex mh-xemacs-use-tool-bar-flag
6429 XEmacs provides a couple of extra options. The first,
6430 @code{mh-xemacs-use-tool-bar-flag}, controls whether to show the MH-E
6431 icons at all. By default, this option is turned on if the window
6432 system supports tool bars. If your system doesn't support tool bars,
6433 then you won't be able to turn on this option.
6435 @vindex mh-xemacs-tool-bar-position
6437 The second extra option is @code{mh-xemacs-tool-bar-position} which
6438 controls the placement of the tool bar along the four edges of the
6439 frame. You can choose from one of @samp{Same As Default Tool Bar},
6440 @samp{Top}, @samp{Bottom}, @samp{Left}, or @samp{Right}. If this
6441 variable is set to anything other than @samp{Same As Default Tool Bar}
6442 and the default tool bar is in a different location, then two tool
6443 bars will be displayed: the MH-E tool bar and the default tool bar.
6445 @node Searching, Threading, Tool Bar, Top
6446 @chapter Searching Through Messages
6448 @cindex @samp{Search} menu
6449 @cindex menu, @samp{Search}
6454 Earlier, the command @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search}) was introduced which
6455 helps you find messages that lie buried in your folders
6456 (@pxref{Folders}). This chapter covers this command in more detail.
6457 Several commands are used to compose the search criteria and to start
6458 searching. A couple of them can be found in the @samp{Search} menu.
6464 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
6465 @c -------------------------
6466 @cindex @samp{Search > Perform Search} menu item
6467 @cindex menu item, @samp{Search > Perform Search}
6469 @findex mh-index-do-search
6471 Find messages using @code{mh-search-program}
6472 (@code{mh-index-do-search}).
6473 @c -------------------------
6474 @cindex @samp{Search > Search with pick} menu item
6475 @cindex menu item, @samp{Search > Search with pick}
6477 @findex mh-pick-do-search
6479 Find messages using @command{pick} (@code{mh-pick-do-search}).
6480 @c -------------------------
6484 Display cheat sheet for the MH-E commands (@code{mh-help}).
6485 @c -------------------------
6491 Move to @samp{Mail-Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6492 @c -------------------------
6497 Move to @samp{Bcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6498 @c -------------------------
6503 Move to @samp{Cc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6504 @c -------------------------
6509 Move to @samp{Dcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6510 @c -------------------------
6515 Move to @samp{Fcc:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6516 @c -------------------------
6521 Move to @samp{Mail-Followup-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6522 @c -------------------------
6527 Move to @samp{From:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6528 @c -------------------------
6533 Move to @samp{Reply-To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6534 @c -------------------------
6539 Move to @samp{Subject:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6540 @c -------------------------
6545 Move to @samp{To:} header field (@code{mh-to-field}).
6548 Another few commands are available in the MH-Folder buffer resulting
6553 @findex mh-index-next-folder
6555 Jump to the next folder marker (@code{mh-index-next-folder}).
6556 @c -------------------------
6558 @findex mh-index-previous-folder
6560 Jump to the previous folder marker (@code{mh-index-previous-folder}).
6561 @c -------------------------
6563 @findex mh-index-visit-folder
6565 Visit original folder from where the message at point was found
6566 (@code{mh-index-visit-folder}).
6569 @cindex @samp{mh-search} customization group
6570 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-search}
6572 There is one option from the @samp{mh-search} customization group used
6576 @item mh-search-program
6577 Search program that MH-E shall use (default: @samp{Auto-detect}).
6580 The following hook is available.
6583 @item mh-search-mode-hook
6584 Hook run upon entry to @code{mh-search-mode} (default: @code{nil}).
6587 The following face is available.
6590 @item mh-search-folder
6591 Folder heading face in MH-Folder buffers created by searches.
6594 @findex mh-search-folder
6597 The command @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search-folder}) helps you find
6598 messages in your entire corpus of mail. You can search for messages to
6599 or from a particular person or about a particular subject. In fact,
6600 you can also search for messages containing selected strings in any
6601 arbitrary header field or any string found within the messages.
6603 @cindex @command{pick}
6604 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
6606 Out of the box, MH-E uses @command{pick} to find messages. With a
6607 little extra effort, you can set an indexing program which rewards you
6608 with extremely quick results. The drawback is that sometimes the index
6609 does not contain the words you're looking for. You can still use
6610 @command{pick} in these situations.
6612 You are prompted for the folder to search. This can be @samp{all} to
6613 search all folders. Note that the search works recursively on the
6616 @cindex MH-Search mode
6617 @cindex modes, MH-Search
6619 Next, an MH-Search buffer appears where you can enter search criteria.
6638 --:** search-pattern All L7 (MH-Search)---------------------------
6639 Type C-c C-c to search messages, C-c C-p to use pick, C-c ? for help
6644 @cindex @command{pick}
6645 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
6647 Edit this template by entering your search criteria in an appropriate
6648 header field that is already there, or create a new field yourself. If
6649 the string you're looking for could be anywhere in a message, then
6650 place the string underneath the row of dashes.
6652 As an example, let's say that we want to find messages from Ginnean
6653 about horseback riding in the Kosciusko National Park (Australia)
6654 during January, 1994. Normally we would start with a broad search and
6655 narrow it down if necessary to produce a manageable amount of data,
6656 but we'll cut to the chase and create a fairly restrictive set of
6657 criteria as follows:
6675 As with MH-Letter mode, MH-Search provides commands like @kbd{C-c C-f
6676 C-t} (@code{mh-to-field}) to help you fill in the blanks.
6677 @xref{Editing Message}.
6680 @vindex mh-search-mode-hook
6682 If you find that you do the same thing over and over when editing the
6683 search template, you may wish to bind some shortcuts to keys. This can
6684 be done with the variable @code{mh-search-mode-hook}, which is called
6685 when @kbd{F s} is run on a new pattern.
6687 @findex mh-index-do-search
6688 @findex mh-pick-do-search
6692 To perform the search, type @kbd{C-c C-c} (@code{mh-index-do-search}).
6693 Sometimes you're searching for text that is either not indexed, or
6694 hasn't been indexed yet. In this case you can override the default
6695 method with the pick method by running the command @kbd{C-c C-p}
6696 (@code{mh-pick-do-search}).
6698 @cindex folders, @samp{+mhe-index}
6699 @cindex @samp{+mhe-index}
6700 @findex mh-index-next-folder
6701 @findex mh-index-previous-folder
6704 @vindex mh-search-folder
6706 The messages that are found are put in a temporary sub-folder of
6707 @samp{+mhe-index} and are displayed in an MH-Folder buffer. This
6708 buffer is special because it displays messages from multiple folders;
6709 each set of messages from a given folder has a heading with the folder
6710 name. The appearance of the heading can be modified by customizing the
6711 face @code{mh-search-folder}. You can jump back and forth between the
6712 headings using the commands @kbd{@key{TAB}}
6713 (@code{mh-index-next-folder}) and @kbd{S-@key{TAB}}
6714 (@code{mh-index-previous-folder}).
6716 @findex mh-index-visit-folder
6717 @findex mh-rescan-folder
6721 In addition, the command @kbd{v} (@code{mh-index-visit-folder}) can be
6722 used to visit the folder of the message at point. Initially, only the
6723 messages that matched the search criteria are displayed in the folder.
6724 While the temporary buffer has its own set of message numbers, the
6725 actual messages numbers are shown in the visited folder. Thus, the
6726 command @kbd{v} is useful to find the actual message number of an
6727 interesting message, or to view surrounding messages with the command
6728 @kbd{F r} @code{mh-rescan-folder}. @xref{Folders}.
6730 @findex mh-kill-folder
6733 Because this folder is temporary, you'll probably get in the habit of
6734 killing it when you're done with @kbd{F k} (@code{mh-kill-folder}).
6739 You can regenerate the results by running @kbd{F s} with a prefix
6742 @cindex @command{procmail}
6743 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
6744 @cindex @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:} header field
6745 @cindex header field, @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:}
6747 Note: This command uses an @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:} header field to
6748 cache the MD5 checksum of a message. This means that if an incoming
6749 message already contains an @samp{X-MHE-Checksum:} field, that message
6750 might not be found by this command. The following @command{procmail}
6751 recipe avoids this problem by renaming the existing header field:
6756 | formail -R "X-MHE-Checksum" "X-Old-MHE-Checksum"
6760 @xref{Limits}, for an alternative interface to searching.
6762 @section Configuring Indexed Searches
6764 @cindex @command{grep}
6765 @cindex @command{mairix}
6766 @cindex @command{namazu}
6767 @cindex @command{pick}
6768 @cindex @command{swish++}
6769 @cindex @command{swish-e}
6770 @cindex Unix commands, @command{grep}
6771 @cindex Unix commands, @command{mairix}
6772 @cindex Unix commands, @command{namazu}
6773 @cindex Unix commands, @command{pick}
6774 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish++}
6775 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish-e}
6778 @vindex mh-search-program
6780 The command @kbd{F s} (@code{mh-search}) runs the command defined by
6781 the option @code{mh-search-program}. The default value is
6782 @samp{Auto-detect} which means that MH-E will automatically choose one
6783 of @command{swish++}, @command{swish-e}, @command{mairix},
6784 @command{namazu}, @command{pick} and @command{grep} in that order. If,
6785 for example, you have both @command{swish++} and @command{mairix}
6786 installed and you want to use @command{mairix}, then you can set this
6787 option to @samp{mairix}.
6789 The following sub-sections describe how to set up the various indexing
6790 programs to use with MH-E.
6794 @cindex @command{swish++}
6795 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish++}
6797 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6800 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish++}. Then
6801 create the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish++/swish++.conf} with the
6806 IncludeMeta Bcc Cc Comments Content-Description From Keywords
6807 IncludeMeta Newsgroups Resent-To Subject To
6808 IncludeMeta Message-Id References In-Reply-To
6810 IndexFile /home/user/Mail/.swish++/swish++.index
6814 Use the following command line to generate the swish index. Run this
6819 find /home/user/Mail -path /home/user/Mail/mhe-index -prune \
6820 -o -path /home/user/Mail/.swish++ -prune \
6821 -o -name "[0-9]*" -print \
6822 | index -c /home/user/Mail/.swish++/swish++.conf -
6826 This command does not index the folders that hold the results of your
6827 searches in @samp{+mhe-index} since they tend to be ephemeral and the
6828 original messages are indexed anyway.
6830 @cindex @command{index}
6831 @cindex Unix commands, @command{index}
6832 @cindex @command{index++}
6833 @cindex Unix commands, @command{index++}
6835 On some systems (Debian GNU/Linux, for example), use @command{index++}
6836 instead of @command{index}.
6840 @cindex @command{swish-e}
6841 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish-e}
6843 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6846 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish}. Then create
6847 the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.swish/config} with the following
6852 DefaultContents TXT*
6853 IndexDir /home/user/Mail
6854 IndexFile /home/user/Mail/.swish/index
6855 IndexName "Mail Index"
6856 IndexDescription "Mail Index"
6857 IndexPointer "http://nowhere"
6859 #MetaNames automatic
6863 IgnoreTotalWordCountWhenRanking yes
6864 WordCharacters abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789-
6865 BeginCharacters abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
6866 EndCharacters abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789
6869 FileRules filename contains \D
6870 FileRules pathname contains /home/user/Mail/.swish
6871 FileRules pathname contains /home/user/Mail/mhe-index
6872 FileRules filename is index
6876 This configuration does not index the folders that hold the results of
6877 your searches in @samp{+mhe-index} since they tend to be ephemeral and
6878 the original messages are indexed anyway.
6880 If there are any directories you would like to ignore, append lines
6881 like the following to @file{config}:
6884 FileRules pathname contains /home/user/Mail/scripts
6887 @cindex @command{swish-e}
6888 @cindex Unix commands, @command{swish-e}
6890 Use the following command line to generate the swish index. Run this
6894 swish-e -c /home/user/Mail/.swish/config
6899 @cindex @command{mairix}
6900 @cindex Unix commands, @command{mairix}
6902 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6905 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.mairix}. Then create
6906 the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.mairix/config} with the following
6911 base=/home/user/Mail
6913 # List of folders that should be indexed. 3 dots at the end means there
6914 # are subfolders within the folder
6915 mh=archive...:inbox:drafts:news:sent:trash
6918 database=/home/user/Mail/mairix/database
6922 Use the following command line to generate the mairix index. Run this daily
6926 mairix -f /home/user/Mail/.mairix/config
6931 @cindex @command{namazu}
6932 @cindex Unix commands, @command{namazu}
6934 In the examples below, replace @file{/home/user/Mail} with the path to
6937 First create the directory @file{/home/user/Mail/.namazu}. Then create
6938 the file @file{/home/user/Mail/.namazu/mknmzrc} with the following
6943 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
6944 $ADDRESS = 'user@@localhost';
6945 $ALLOW_FILE = "[0-9]*";
6946 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "^/home/user/Mail/(mhe-index|spam)";
6950 This configuration does not index the folders that hold the results of
6951 your searches in @samp{+mhe-index} since they tend to be ephemeral and
6952 the original messages are indexed anyway.
6954 Use the following command line to generate the namazu index. Run this
6958 mknmz -f /home/user/Mail/.namazu/mknmzrc -O /home/user/Mail/.namazu \
6964 @cindex @command{pick}
6965 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
6967 This search method does not require any setup.
6969 Read @command{pick}(1) or the section
6970 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/finpic.html, Finding Messages with pick} in
6971 the MH book to find out more about how to enter the criteria.
6975 @cindex @command{grep}
6976 @cindex Unix commands, @command{grep}
6978 This search method does not require any setup.
6980 Unlike the other search methods, this method does not use the
6981 MH-Search buffer. Instead, you simply enter a regular expression in
6982 the minibuffer. For help in constructing regular expressions, see your
6983 man page for @command{grep}.
6985 @node Threading, Limits, Searching, Top
6986 @chapter Viewing Message Threads
6990 MH-E groups messages by @dfn{threads} which are messages that are part
6991 of the same discussion and usually all have the same @samp{Subject:}
6992 header field. Other ways to organize messages in a folder include
6993 limiting (@pxref{Limits}) or using full-text indexed searches
6994 (@pxref{Searching}).
6996 @cindex root, in threads
6997 @cindex siblings, in threads
6998 @cindex ancestor, in threads
7000 A thread begins with a single message called a @dfn{root}. All replies
7001 to the same message are @dfn{siblings} of each other. Any message that
7002 has replies to it is an @dfn{ancestor} of those replies.
7004 There are several commands that you can use to navigate and operate on
7009 @findex mh-prefix-help
7011 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7012 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7013 @c -------------------------
7015 @findex mh-thread-refile
7017 Refile (output) thread into folder (@code{mh-thread-refile}).
7018 @c -------------------------
7020 @findex mh-thread-delete
7022 Delete thread (@code{mh-thread-delete}).
7023 @c -------------------------
7025 @findex mh-toggle-threads
7027 Toggle threaded view of folder (@code{mh-toggle-threads}).
7028 @c -------------------------
7030 @findex mh-thread-next-sibling
7032 Display next sibling (@code{mh-thread-next-sibling}).
7033 @c -------------------------
7035 @findex mh-thread-previous-sibling
7037 Display previous sibling (@code{mh-thread-previous-sibling}).
7038 @c -------------------------
7040 @findex mh-thread-ancestor
7042 Display ancestor of current message (@code{mh-thread-ancestor}).
7045 @cindex @samp{mh-thread} customization group
7046 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-thread}
7048 The @samp{mh-thread} customization group contains one option.
7051 @item mh-show-threads-flag
7052 On means new folders start in threaded mode (default: @samp{off}).
7055 @findex mh-toggle-threads
7057 @vindex mh-large-folder
7058 @vindex mh-show-threads-flag
7060 Threading large number of messages can be time consuming so the option
7061 @code{mh-show-threads-flag} is turned off by default. If you turn on
7062 this option, then threading will be done only if the number of
7063 messages being threaded is less than @code{mh-large-folder}. In any
7064 event, threading can be turned on (and off) with the command @kbd{T t}
7065 (@code{mh-toggle-threads}).
7067 @findex mh-thread-ancestor
7068 @findex mh-thread-next-sibling
7069 @findex mh-thread-previous-sibling
7074 There are a few commands to help you navigate threads. If you do not
7075 care for the way a particular thread has turned, you can move up the
7076 chain of messages with the command @kbd{T u}
7077 (@code{mh-thread-ancestor}. At any point you can use @kbd{T n}
7078 (@code{mh-thread-next-sibling} or @kbd{T p}
7079 (@code{mh-thread-previous-sibling}) to jump to the next or previous
7080 sibling, skipping the sub-threads. The command @kbd{T u} can also take
7081 a prefix argument to jump to the message that started everything.
7083 @findex mh-delete-subject-or-thread
7084 @findex mh-thread-delete
7085 @findex mh-thread-refile
7090 There are threaded equivalents for the commands that delete and refile
7091 messages. For example, @kbd{T o} (@code{mh-thread-refile}) refiles the
7092 current message and all its children. Similarly, the command @kbd{T d}
7093 (@code{mh-thread-delete}) deletes the current message and all its
7094 children. These commands do not refile or delete sibling messages.
7095 @xref{Navigating}, for a description of the similar command @kbd{k}
7096 (@code{mh-delete-subject-or-thread}).
7098 @vindex mh-large-folder
7100 If you find that threading is too slow, it may be that you have
7101 @code{mh-large-folder} set too high. Also, threading is one of the few
7102 features of MH-E that really benefits from compiling. If you haven't
7103 compiled MH-E, I encourage you to do so@footnote{If you're not sure if
7104 MH-E has been byte-compiled, you could try running @samp{locate
7105 mh-thread.elc} or otherwise find MH-E on your system and ensure that
7106 @file{mh-thread.elc} exists. If you have multiple versions and you
7107 find that one is compiled but the other is not, then go into your
7108 @samp{*scratch*} buffer in Emacs, enter @kbd{load-path C-j}, and
7109 ensure that the byte-compiled version appears first in the
7110 @code{load-path}. If you find that MH-E is not compiled and you
7111 installed MH-E yourself, please refer to the installation directions
7112 in the file @file{README} in the distribution.}.
7114 @node Limits, Sequences, Threading, Top
7115 @chapter Limiting Display
7120 Another way to organize messages in a folder besides threading
7121 (@pxref{Threading}) or using full-text indexed searches
7122 (@pxref{Searching}) is by limiting the folder display to messages that
7123 are similar to the current message.
7127 @findex mh-prefix-help
7129 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7130 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7131 @c -------------------------
7132 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence} menu item
7133 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence}
7135 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7137 Limit to messages in the @samp{tick} sequence
7138 (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}).
7139 @c -------------------------
7141 @findex mh-narrow-to-cc
7143 Limit to messages with the same @samp{Cc:} field
7144 (@code{mh-narrow-to-cc}).
7145 @c -------------------------
7147 @findex mh-narrow-to-from
7149 Limit to messages with the same @samp{From:} field
7150 (@code{mh-narrow-to-from}).
7151 @c -------------------------
7153 @findex mh-narrow-to-range
7155 Limit to range (@code{mh-narrow-to-range}).
7156 @c -------------------------
7157 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Subject Sequence} menu item
7158 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Subject Sequence}
7160 @findex mh-narrow-to-subject
7162 Limit to messages with the same @samp{Subject:} field
7163 (@code{mh-narrow-to-subject}).
7164 @c -------------------------
7166 @findex mh-narrow-to-to
7168 Limit to messages with the same @samp{To:} field
7169 (@code{mh-narrow-to-to}).
7170 @c -------------------------
7171 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence} menu item
7172 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence}
7176 Remove last restriction (@code{mh-widen}).
7179 All of the limiting commands above refine the display in some way.
7181 @cindex @command{pick}
7182 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
7183 @findex mh-narrow-to-cc
7184 @findex mh-narrow-to-from
7185 @findex mh-narrow-to-subject
7186 @findex mh-narrow-to-to
7192 The commands @kbd{/ c} (@code{mh-narrow-to-cc}), @kbd{/ m}
7193 (@code{mh-narrow-to-from}), @kbd{/ s} (@code{mh-narrow-to-subject}),
7194 and @kbd{/ t} (@code{mh-narrow-to-to}) restrict the display to
7195 messages matching the content of the respective field in the current
7196 message. However, you can give any of these a prefix argument to edit
7197 the @command{pick} expression used to narrow the view@footnote{See
7198 @command{pick}(1) or the section
7199 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/finpic.html, Finding Messages with pick} in
7202 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
7203 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
7204 @cindex ticked messages, viewing
7205 @findex mh-narrow-to-range
7206 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7210 You can also limit the display to messages in the @samp{tick} sequence
7211 with the command @kbd{/ '} (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}).
7212 @xref{Sequences}, for information on putting message into the
7213 @samp{tick} sequence. Use the @kbd{/ g} (@code{mh-narrow-to-range})
7214 command to limit the display to messages in a range (@pxref{Ranges}).
7219 Each limit can be undone in turn with the @kbd{/ w} (@code{mh-widen})
7220 command. Give this command a prefix argument to remove all limits.
7222 @node Sequences, Junk, Limits, Top
7223 @chapter Using Sequences
7225 @cindex @samp{Sequence} menu
7226 @cindex menu, @samp{Sequence}
7229 For the whole scoop on MH sequences, refer to
7230 @samp{mh-sequence}(5)@footnote{See the section
7231 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/morseq.html, More About Sequences} in the MH
7232 book.}. As you've read, several of the MH-E commands can operate on a
7233 sequence, which is a shorthand for a range or group of messages. For
7234 example, you might want to forward several messages to a friend or
7235 colleague. Here's how to manipulate sequences. These commands are also
7236 available in the @samp{Sequence} menu.
7239 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Toggle Tick Mark} menu item
7240 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Toggle Tick Mark}
7242 @findex mh-toggle-tick
7244 Toggle tick mark of range (@code{mh-toggle-tick}).
7245 @c -------------------------
7247 @findex mh-prefix-help
7249 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7250 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7251 @c -------------------------
7252 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence} menu item
7253 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Tick Sequence}
7255 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7257 Limit to ticked messages (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}).
7258 @c -------------------------
7259 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Delete Message from Sequence...} menu item
7260 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Delete Message from Sequence...}
7262 @findex mh-delete-msg-from-seq
7264 Delete range from sequence (@code{mh-delete-msg-from-seq}).
7265 @c -------------------------
7266 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Delete Sequence...} menu item
7267 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Delete Sequence...}
7269 @findex mh-delete-seq
7271 Delete sequence (@code{mh-delete-seq}).
7272 @c -------------------------
7273 @cindex @samp{Sequence > List Sequences in Folder...} menu item
7274 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > List Sequences in Folder...}
7276 @findex mh-list-sequences
7278 List all sequences in folder (@code{mh-list-sequences}).
7279 @c -------------------------
7280 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Sequence...} menu item
7281 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Narrow to Sequence...}
7283 @findex mh-narrow-to-seq
7285 Restrict display to messages in sequence (@code{mh-narrow-to-seq}).
7286 @c -------------------------
7287 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Add Message to Sequence...} menu item
7288 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Add Message to Sequence...}
7290 @findex mh-put-msg-in-seq
7292 Add range to sequence (@code{mh-put-msg-in-seq}).
7293 @c -------------------------
7294 @cindex @samp{Sequence > List Sequences for Message} menu item
7295 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > List Sequences for Message}
7297 @findex mh-msg-is-in-seq
7299 Display the sequences in which the current message appears
7300 (@code{mh-msg-is-in-seq}).
7301 @c -------------------------
7302 @cindex @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence} menu item
7303 @cindex menu item, @samp{Sequence > Widen from Sequence}
7307 Remove last restriction (@code{mh-widen}).
7308 @c -------------------------
7309 @findex mh-update-sequences
7310 @item M-x mh-update-sequences
7311 Flush MH-E's state out to MH@.
7314 @cindex @samp{mh-sequences} customization group
7315 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-sequences}
7317 The @samp{mh-sequences} customization group contains the options
7318 associated with sequences.
7321 @item mh-refile-preserves-sequences-flag
7322 On means that sequences are preserved when messages are refiled
7323 (default: @samp{on}).
7324 @c -------------------------
7326 The name of the MH sequence for ticked messages (default: @samp{'tick}).
7327 @c -------------------------
7328 @item mh-update-sequences-after-mh-show-flag
7329 On means flush MH sequences to disk after message is shown (default:
7333 The following hook is available.
7336 @item mh-unseen-updated-hook
7337 Hook run after the unseen sequence has been updated (default: @code{nil}).
7340 @cindex @command{pick}
7341 @cindex MH commands, @command{pick}
7342 @findex mh-put-msg-in-seq
7345 To place a message in a sequence, use @kbd{S p}
7346 (@code{mh-put-msg-in-seq}). Give @kbd{S p} a range and you can add all
7347 the messages in a sequence to another sequence (for example, @kbd{C-u
7348 S p SourceSequence @key{RET} DestSequence @key{RET}}, @pxref{Ranges}).
7350 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
7351 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
7352 @cindex ticking messages
7353 @findex mh-index-ticked-messages
7354 @findex mh-toggle-tick
7359 One specific use of the @kbd{S p} command is @kbd{'}
7360 (@code{mh-toggle-tick}) which adds messages to the @samp{tick}
7361 sequence. This sequence can be viewed later with the @kbd{F '}
7362 (@code{mh-index-ticked-messages}) command (@pxref{Folders}).
7366 You can customize the option @code{mh-tick-seq} if you already use the
7367 @samp{tick} sequence for your own use. You can also disable all of the
7368 ticking functions by choosing the @samp{Disable Ticking} item but
7369 there isn't much advantage to that.
7371 @cindex MH-Folder mode
7372 @cindex modes, MH-Folder
7373 @findex mh-narrow-to-seq
7374 @findex mh-narrow-to-tick
7380 Once you've placed some messages in a sequence, you may wish to narrow
7381 the field of view to just those messages in the sequence you've
7382 created. To do this, use @kbd{S n} (@code{mh-narrow-to-seq}). You are
7383 prompted for the name of the sequence. What this does is show only
7384 those messages that are in the selected sequence in the MH-Folder
7385 buffer. In addition, it limits further MH-E searches to just those
7386 messages. To narrow the view to the messages in the @samp{tick}
7387 sequence, use @kbd{S '} (@code{mh-narrow-to-tick}). When you want to
7388 widen the view to all your messages again, use @kbd{S w}
7391 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7392 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7393 @findex mh-list-sequences
7394 @findex mh-msg-is-in-seq
7398 You can see which sequences in which a message appears with the
7399 command @kbd{S s} (@code{mh-msg-is-in-seq}). Use a prefix argument to
7400 display the sequences in which another message appears (as in @kbd{C-u
7401 42 S s @key{RET}}). Or, you can list all sequences in a selected
7402 folder (default is current folder) with @kbd{S l}
7403 (@code{mh-list-sequences}). The list appears in a buffer named
7404 @samp{*MH-E Sequences*} (@pxref{Miscellaneous}).
7406 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Previous-Sequence:}
7407 @cindex @samp{cur} sequence
7408 @cindex @samp{Previous-Sequence:} MH profile component
7409 @cindex sequence, @samp{cur}
7410 @cindex sequence, @samp{Previous-Sequence}
7411 @vindex mh-refile-preserves-sequences-flag
7413 If a message is in any sequence (except
7414 @samp{Previous-Sequence:}@footnote{See @samp{mh-profile}(5)).} and
7415 @samp{cur}) when it is refiled, then it will still be in those
7416 sequences in the destination folder. If this behavior is not desired,
7417 then turn off the option @code{mh-refile-preserves-sequences-flag}.
7419 @findex mh-delete-msg-from-seq
7420 @findex mh-delete-seq
7425 If you want to remove a message (or range, @pxref{Ranges}) from a
7426 sequence, use @kbd{S d} (@code{mh-delete-msg-from-seq}). If you want
7427 to delete an entire sequence, use @kbd{S k} (@code{mh-delete-seq}). In
7428 the latter case you are prompted for the sequence to delete. Note that
7429 this deletes only the sequence, not the messages in the sequence. If
7430 you want to delete the messages, use @kbd{C-u d} (@pxref{Reading
7433 @cindex @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} MH profile component
7434 @cindex @samp{cur} sequence
7435 @cindex @samp{tick} sequence
7436 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}
7437 @cindex sequence, @samp{Unseen-Sequence}
7438 @cindex sequence, @samp{cur}
7439 @cindex sequence, @samp{tick}
7440 @findex mh-update-sequences
7441 @kindex M-x mh-update-sequences
7445 @vindex mh-update-sequences-after-mh-show-flag
7447 Three sequences are maintained internally by MH-E and pushed out to MH
7448 when a message is shown. They include the sequence specified by your
7449 @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} profile component, @samp{cur}, and the
7450 sequence listed by the option @code{mh-tick-seq} which is @samp{tick}
7451 by default. If you do not like this behavior, turn off the option
7452 @code{mh-update-sequences-after-mh-show-flag}. You can then update the
7453 state manually with the @kbd{x}, @kbd{q}, or @kbd{M-x
7454 mh-update-sequences} commands.
7456 @vindex mh-seen-list
7457 @vindex mh-unseen-updated-hook
7459 The hook @code{mh-unseen-updated-hook} is run after the unseen
7460 sequence has been updated. The variable @code{mh-seen-list} can be
7461 used by this hook to obtain the list of messages which were removed
7462 from the unseen sequence.
7464 @cindex @command{mark}
7465 @cindex MH commands, @command{mark}
7469 With the exceptions of @kbd{S n} and @kbd{S w}, the underlying MH
7470 command dealing with sequences is @command{mark}@footnote{See the
7471 section @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/mmbwm.html, Make Message Bookmarks
7472 with mark} in the MH book.}.
7474 @node Junk, Miscellaneous, Sequences, Top
7475 @chapter Dealing With Junk Mail
7477 @cindex Marshall Rose
7481 Marshall Rose once wrote a paper on MH entitled, @cite{How to process
7482 200 messages a day and still get some real work done}. This chapter
7483 could be entitled, @cite{How to process 1000 spams a day and still get
7484 some real work done}.
7486 @cindex blacklisting
7489 @cindex whitelisting
7492 We use the terms @dfn{junk mail} and @dfn{spam} interchangeably for
7493 any unwanted message which includes spam, @dfn{viruses}, and
7494 @dfn{worms}. The opposite of spam is @dfn{ham}. The act of classifying
7495 a sender as one who sends junk mail is called @dfn{blacklisting}; the
7496 opposite is called @dfn{whitelisting}.
7500 @findex mh-prefix-help
7502 Display cheat sheet for the commands of the current prefix in
7503 minibuffer (@code{mh-prefix-help}).
7504 @c -------------------------
7506 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7508 Blacklist range as spam (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}).
7509 @c -------------------------
7511 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7513 Whitelist range as ham (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}).
7514 @c -------------------------
7515 @item @code{mh-spamassassin-identify-spammers}
7516 Identify spammers who are repeat offenders.
7519 @cindex @samp{mh-junk} customization group
7520 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-junk}
7522 The following table lists the options from the @samp{mh-junk}
7523 customization group.
7526 @item mh-junk-background
7527 If on, spam programs are run in background (default: @samp{off}).
7528 @c -------------------------
7529 @item mh-junk-disposition
7530 Disposition of junk mail (default: @samp{Delete Spam}).
7531 @c -------------------------
7532 @item mh-junk-program
7533 Spam program that MH-E should use (default: @samp{Auto-detect}).
7537 @cindex Spamassassin
7539 @cindex spam filters, SpamProbe
7540 @cindex spam filters, Spamassassin
7541 @cindex spam filters, bogofilter
7543 MH-E depends on @uref{http://spamassassin.apache.org/, SpamAssassin},
7544 @uref{http://bogofilter.sourceforge.net/, bogofilter}, or
7545 @uref{http://spamprobe.sourceforge.net/, SpamProbe} to throw the dreck
7546 away. This chapter describes briefly how to configure these programs
7547 to work well with MH-E and how to use MH-E's interface that provides
7548 continuing education for these programs.
7550 @vindex mh-junk-program
7552 The default setting of the option @code{mh-junk-program} is
7553 @samp{Auto-detect} which means that MH-E will automatically choose one
7554 of SpamAssassin, bogofilter, or SpamProbe in that order. If, for
7555 example, you have both SpamAssassin and bogofilter installed and you
7556 want to use bogofilter, then you can set this option to
7559 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7561 @vindex mh-junk-disposition
7563 The command @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) trains the spam
7564 program in use with the content of the range (@pxref{Ranges}) and then
7565 handles the message(s) as specified by the option
7566 @code{mh-junk-disposition}. By default, this option is set to
7567 @samp{Delete Spam} but you can also specify the name of the folder
7568 which is useful for building a corpus of spam for training purposes.
7570 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7573 In contrast, the command @kbd{J w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist})
7574 reclassifies a range of messages (@pxref{Ranges}) as ham if it were
7575 incorrectly classified as spam. It then refiles the message into the
7576 @file{+inbox} folder.
7578 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7579 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7580 @findex call-process
7581 @vindex mh-junk-background
7583 By default, the programs are run in the foreground, but this can be
7584 slow when junking large numbers of messages. If you have enough memory
7585 or don't junk that many messages at the same time, you might try
7586 turning on the option @code{mh-junk-background}. @footnote{Note that
7587 the option @code{mh-junk-background} is used as the @code{display}
7588 argument in the call to @code{call-process}. Therefore, turning on
7589 this option means setting its value to @samp{0}. You can also set its
7590 value to @samp{t} to direct the programs' output to the @samp{*MH-E
7591 Log*} buffer; this may be useful for debugging.}
7593 The following sections discuss the various counter-spam measures that
7596 @cindex @file{.procmailrc}
7597 @cindex files, @file{.procmailrc}
7599 @subheading SpamAssassin
7601 @cindex Spamassassin
7602 @cindex spam filters, Spamassassin
7604 SpamAssassin is one of the more popular spam filtering programs. Get
7605 it from your local distribution or from the
7606 @uref{http://spamassassin.apache.org/, SpamAssassin web site}.
7608 To use SpamAssassin, add the following recipes to @file{~/.procmailrc}:
7610 @cindex @command{spamc}
7611 @cindex @samp{X-Spam-Level:} header field
7612 @cindex @samp{X-Spam-Status:} header field
7613 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Spam-Level:}
7614 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Spam-Status:}
7617 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7618 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7620 # Fight spam with SpamAssassin.
7624 # Anything with a spam level of 10 or more is junked immediately.
7626 * ^X-Spam-Level: ..........
7630 * ^X-Spam-Status: Yes
7634 If you don't use @command{spamc}, use @samp{spamassassin -P -a}.
7636 Note that one of the recipes above throws away messages with a score
7637 greater than or equal to 10. Here's how you can determine a value that
7640 First, run @samp{spamassassin -t} on every mail message in your
7641 archive and use @command{gnumeric} to verify that the average plus the
7642 standard deviation of good mail is under 5, the SpamAssassin default
7645 Using @command{gnumeric}, sort the messages by score and view the
7646 messages with the highest score. Determine the score which encompasses
7647 all of your interesting messages and add a couple of points to be
7648 conservative. Add that many dots to the @samp{X-Spam-Level:} header
7649 field above to send messages with that score down the drain.
7651 In the example above, messages with a score of 5-9 are set aside in
7652 the @samp{+spam} folder for later review. The major weakness of
7653 rules-based filters is a plethora of false positives so it is
7654 worthwhile to check.
7656 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7657 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7661 If SpamAssassin classifies a message incorrectly, or is unsure, you can
7662 use the MH-E commands @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) and
7663 @kbd{J w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}).
7665 @cindex @command{sa-learn}
7666 @cindex @file{.spamassassin/user_prefs}
7667 @cindex files, @file{.spamassassin/user_prefs}
7669 The command @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) adds a
7670 @samp{blacklist_from} entry to @file{~/spamassassin/user_prefs},
7671 deletes the message, and sends the message to the Razor, so that
7672 others might not see this spam. If the @command{sa-learn} command is
7673 available, the message is also recategorized as spam.
7675 The command@kbd{J w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}) adds a
7676 @samp{whitelist_from} rule to @samp{~/.spamassassin/user_prefs}. If
7677 the @command{sa-learn} command is available, the message is also
7678 recategorized as ham.
7680 Over time, you'll observe that the same host or domain occurs
7681 repeatedly in the @samp{blacklist_from} entries, so you might think
7682 that you could avoid future spam by blacklisting all mail from a
7683 particular domain. The utility function
7684 @code{mh-spamassassin-identify-spammers} helps you do precisely that.
7685 This function displays a frequency count of the hosts and domains in
7686 the @samp{blacklist_from} entries from the last blank line in
7687 @file{~/.spamassassin/user_prefs} to the end of the file. This
7688 information can be used so that you can replace multiple
7689 @samp{blacklist_from} entries with a single wildcard entry such as:
7692 blacklist_from *@@*amazingoffersdirect2u.com
7695 In versions of SpamAssassin (2.50 and on) that support a Bayesian
7696 classifier, @kbd{J b} @code{(mh-junk-blacklist}) uses the program
7697 @command{sa-learn} to recategorize the message as spam. Neither MH-E,
7698 nor SpamAssassin, rebuilds the database after adding words, so you
7699 will need to run @samp{sa-learn --rebuild} periodically. This can be
7700 done by adding the following to your @file{crontab}:
7703 0 * * * * sa-learn --rebuild > /dev/null 2>&1
7706 @subheading Bogofilter
7709 @cindex spam filters, bogofilter
7711 Bogofilter is a Bayesian spam filtering program. Get it from your
7712 local distribution or from the
7713 @uref{http://bogofilter.sourceforge.net/, bogofilter web site}.
7715 Bogofilter is taught by running:
7718 bogofilter -n < good-message
7721 on every good message, and
7724 bogofilter -s < spam-message
7727 @cindex full training
7729 on every spam message. This is called a @dfn{full training}; three
7730 other training methods are described in the FAQ that is distributed
7731 with bogofilter. Note that most Bayesian filters need 1000 to 5000 of
7732 each type of message to start doing a good job.
7734 To use bogofilter, add the following recipes to @file{~/.procmailrc}:
7736 @cindex @samp{X-Bogosity:} header field
7737 @cindex header field, @samp{X-Bogosity:}
7740 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7741 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7743 # Fight spam with Bogofilter.
7745 | bogofilter -3 -e -p
7748 * ^X-Bogosity: Yes, tests=bogofilter
7752 * ^X-Bogosity: Unsure, tests=bogofilter
7756 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7757 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7761 If bogofilter classifies a message incorrectly, or is unsure, you can
7762 use the MH-E commands @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) and @kbd{J
7763 w} (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}) to update bogofilter's training.
7765 The @cite{Bogofilter FAQ} suggests that you run the following
7766 occasionally to shrink the database:
7769 bogoutil -d wordlist.db | bogoutil -l wordlist.db.new
7770 mv wordlist.db wordlist.db.prv
7771 mv wordlist.db.new wordlist.db
7774 The @cite{Bogofilter tuning HOWTO} describes how you can fine-tune
7777 @subheading SpamProbe
7780 @cindex spam filters, SpamProbe
7782 SpamProbe is a Bayesian spam filtering program. Get it from your local
7783 distribution or from the @uref{http://spamprobe.sourceforge.net,
7784 SpamProbe web site}.
7786 To use SpamProbe, add the following recipes to @file{~/.procmailrc}:
7788 @cindex @command{formail}
7789 @cindex @samp{X-SpamProbe:} header field
7790 @cindex header field, @samp{X-SpamProbe:}
7793 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7794 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7796 # Fight spam with SpamProbe.
7798 SCORE=| spamprobe receive
7801 | formail -I "X-SpamProbe: $SCORE"
7808 @findex mh-junk-blacklist
7809 @findex mh-junk-whitelist
7813 If SpamProbe classifies a message incorrectly, you can use the MH-E
7814 commands @kbd{J b} (@code{mh-junk-blacklist}) and @kbd{J w}
7815 (@code{mh-junk-whitelist}) to update SpamProbe's training.
7817 @subheading Other Things You Can Do
7819 There are a couple of things that you can add to @file{~/.procmailrc}
7820 in order to filter out a lot of spam and viruses. The first is to
7821 eliminate any message with a Windows executable (which is most likely
7822 a virus). The second is to eliminate mail in character sets that you
7825 @cindex @samp{Content-Transfer-Encoding:} header field
7826 @cindex @samp{Content-Type:} header field
7827 @cindex @samp{Subject:} header field
7828 @cindex header field, @samp{Content-Transfer-Encoding:}
7829 @cindex header field, @samp{Content-Type:}
7830 @cindex header field, @samp{Subject:}
7833 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
7834 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
7837 # Filter messages with win32 executables/virii.
7839 # These attachments are base64 and have a TVqQAAMAAAAEAAAA//8AALg
7840 # pattern. The string "this program cannot be run in MS-DOS mode"
7841 # encoded in base64 is 4fug4AtAnNIbg and helps to avoid false
7842 # positives (Roland Smith via Pete from the bogofilter mailing list).
7845 * ^Content-Transfer-Encoding:.*base64
7846 * ^TVqQAAMAAAAEAAAA//8AALg
7851 # Filter mail in unreadable character sets (from the Bogofilter FAQ).
7853 UNREADABLE='[^?"]*big5|iso-2022-jp|ISO-2022-KR|euc-kr|gb2312|ks_c_5601-1987'
7856 * 1^0 $ ^Subject:.*=\?($UNREADABLE)
7857 * 1^0 $ ^Content-Type:.*charset="?($UNREADABLE)
7861 * ^Content-Type:.*multipart
7862 * B ?? $ ^Content-Type:.*^?.*charset="?($UNREADABLE)
7866 @node Miscellaneous, Scan Line Formats, Junk, Top
7867 @chapter Miscellaneous Commands, Variables, and Buffers
7869 This chapter covers the following command and the various MH-E
7874 Display version information about MH-E and the MH mail handling
7878 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7879 @cindex MH-E version
7880 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7882 @kindex M-x mh-version
7884 One command worth noting is @kbd{M-x mh-version}. You can compare the
7885 version this command prints to the latest release (@pxref{Getting
7886 MH-E}). The output of @kbd{M-x mh-version}, found in a buffer named
7887 @samp{*MH-E Info*}, should usually be included with any bug report you
7888 submit (@pxref{Bug Reports}).
7890 @subheading MH-E Buffers
7892 Besides the MH-Folder, MH-Show, and MH-Letter buffers, MH-E creates
7893 several other buffers. They are:
7896 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
7897 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Folders*}
7898 @findex mh-list-folders
7899 @item *MH-E Folders*
7901 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{F l} (@code{mh-list-folders}).
7903 @c -------------------------
7904 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Help*}
7905 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Help*}
7910 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{?} (@code{mh-help}) and
7911 @kbd{C-c ?} in MH-Letter mode. @xref{Using This Manual}.
7912 @c -------------------------
7913 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7914 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Info*}
7916 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{M-x mh-version @key{RET}}.
7917 @c -------------------------
7918 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7919 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Log*}
7921 This buffer contains the last 100 lines of the output of the various
7923 @c -------------------------
7924 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
7925 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Mail Delivery*}
7926 @item *MH-E Mail Delivery*
7927 This buffer contains the transcript of a mail delivery. @xref{Sending
7929 @c -------------------------
7930 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
7931 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Recipients*}
7932 @findex mh-check-whom
7933 @item *MH-E Recipients*
7935 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{C-c C-w}
7936 (@code{mh-check-whom}) and is killed when draft is sent.
7937 @xref{Checking Recipients}.
7938 @c -------------------------
7939 @cindex @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7940 @cindex buffers, @samp{*MH-E Sequences*}
7941 @item *MH-E Sequences*
7942 This buffer contains the output of @kbd{S l}
7943 (@code{mh-list-sequences}). @xref{Sequences}.
7944 @c -------------------------
7945 @cindex @samp{*mh-temp*}
7946 @cindex buffers, @samp{*mh-temp*}
7948 This is a scratch, ephemeral, buffer used by MH-E functions. Note that
7949 it is hidden because the first character in the name is a space.
7950 You'll generally not have any need for this buffer.
7953 @node Scan Line Formats, Procmail, Miscellaneous, Top
7954 @appendix Scan Line Formats
7956 @cindex scan line formats
7958 This appendix discusses how MH-E creates, parses, and manipulates scan
7959 lines. If you have your own MH scan or inc format files, you
7960 @strong{can} teach MH-E how to handle them, but it isn't easy as
7963 @cindex @samp{mh-scan-line-formats} customization group
7964 @cindex customization group, @samp{mh-scan-line-formats}
7966 This table lists the options in the @samp{mh-scan-line-formats}
7967 customization group.
7970 @item mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
7971 On means that the message number width is determined dynamically
7972 (default: @samp{on}).
7973 @c -------------------------
7974 @item mh-scan-format-file
7975 Specifies the format file to pass to the scan program (default:
7976 @samp{Use MH-E scan Format}).
7977 @c -------------------------
7979 Program used to scan messages (default: @code{"scan"}).
7982 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
7984 There are a couple of caveats when creating your own scan format file.
7985 First, MH-E will not work if your scan lines do not include message
7986 numbers. It will work poorly if you don't dedicate a column for
7987 showing the current message and notations. You won't be able to use
7988 the option @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag} or the threading features
7989 (@pxref{Threading}).
7991 @cindex message numbers
7992 @findex mh-set-cmd-note
7993 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
7994 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
7996 If you've created your own format to handle long message numbers,
7997 you'll be pleased to know you no longer need it since MH-E adapts its
7998 internal format based upon the largest message number if
7999 @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag} is on (the default). If you prefer
8000 fixed-width message numbers, turn off @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag}
8001 and call @code{mh-set-cmd-note} with the width specified by your
8002 format file (see @code{mh-scan-format-file}). For example, the default
8003 width is 4, so you would use @samp{(mh-set-cmd-note 4)}.
8005 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
8006 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8007 @vindex mh-scan-format-mh
8008 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
8010 The default setting for @code{mh-scan-format-file} is @samp{Use MH-E
8011 scan Format}. This means that the format string will be taken from the
8012 either @code{mh-scan-format-mh} or @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} depending
8013 on whether MH or nmh (or GNU mailutils) is in use. This setting also
8014 enables you to turn on the option @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag}.
8015 You can also set this option to @samp{Use Default scan Format} to get
8016 the same output as you would get if you ran @command{scan} from the
8017 shell. If you have a format file that you want MH-E to use but not MH,
8018 you can set this option to @samp{Specify a scan Format File} and enter
8019 the name of your format file.
8021 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8022 @vindex mh-scan-format-mh
8023 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
8025 The scan format that MH-E uses when @code{mh-scan-format-file} is set
8026 to its default of @samp{Use MH-E scan Format} is held in the variables
8027 @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} and @code{mh-scan-format-mh} depending on
8028 whether you are using nmh (or GNU mailutils) or not. Typically, you
8029 create your own format files rather than modifying these variables.
8030 The value of @code{mh-scan-format-nmh} is:
8037 "%?(nonnull(comp@{to@}))%<(mymbox@{to@})t%>"
8038 "%?(nonnull(comp@{cc@}))%<(mymbox@{cc@})c%>"
8039 "%?(nonnull(comp@{bcc@}))%<(mymbox@{bcc@})b%>"
8040 "%?(nonnull(comp@{newsgroups@}))n%>"
8042 "%02(mon@{date@})/%02(mday@{date@})%<@{date@} %|*%>"
8043 "%<(mymbox@{from@})%<@{to@}To:%14(decode(friendly@{to@}))%>%>"
8044 "%<(zero)%17(decode(friendly@{from@}))%> "
8045 "%(decode@{subject@})%<@{body@}<<%@{body@}%>")
8048 @cindex decoding RFC 2047
8049 @cindex RFC 2047, decoding
8050 @vindex mh-scan-format-mh
8052 The setting for @code{mh-scan-format-mh} is similar, except that MH
8053 doesn't have the function @code{decode} (which is used to decode RFC
8056 @cindex notations, scan line
8057 @cindex scan line notations
8059 These strings are passed to the @command{scan} program via the
8060 @option{-format} argument. The formats are identical to the defaults
8061 except that additional hints for fontification have been added to the
8062 existing notations in the fifth column (remember that in Emacs, the
8063 columns start at 0). The values of the fifth column, in priority
8064 order, are: @samp{-} if the message has been replied to, @samp{t} if
8065 an address in the @samp{To:} field matches one of the mailboxes of the
8066 current user, @samp{c} if the @samp{Cc:} field matches, @samp{b} if
8067 the @samp{Bcc:} field matches, and @samp{n} if a non-empty
8068 @samp{Newsgroups:} field is present.
8070 @cindex @command{scan}
8071 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
8073 @vindex mh-scan-prog
8075 The name of the program that generates a listing of one line per
8076 message is held in @code{mh-scan-prog} (default: @code{"scan"}).
8077 Unless this variable contains an absolute pathname, it is assumed to
8078 be in the @code{mh-progs} directory (@pxref{Getting Started}). You may
8079 link another program to @command{scan} (see @samp{mh-profile}(5)) to
8080 produce a different type of listing@footnote{See the section
8081 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/faswsprs.html, Find and Specify with scan
8082 pick Ranges Sequences} in the MH book.}.
8084 @cindex regular expressions, scan line formats
8085 @findex mh-set-cmd-note
8088 If you change the format of the scan lines you'll need to tell MH-E
8089 how to parse the new format. As you will see, quite a lot of variables
8090 are involved to do that. Use @kbd{M-x apropos @key{RET}
8091 mh-scan.*regexp @key{RET}} to obtain a list of these variables. You
8092 will also have to call @code{mh-set-cmd-note} if your notations are
8093 not in column 4 (columns in Emacs start with 0). Note that unlike most
8094 of the user options described in this manual, these are variables and
8095 must be set with @code{setq} instead of in a customization buffer. For
8096 help with regular expressions, see
8098 @ref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The
8103 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/manual/html_node/Regexps.html,
8104 Syntax of Regular Expressions} in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
8107 The first variable has to do with pruning out garbage.
8110 @cindex @command{inc}
8111 @cindex MH commands, @command{inc}
8112 @cindex @command{scan}
8113 @cindex MH commands, @command{scan}
8114 @item mh-scan-valid-regexp
8115 This regular expression describes a valid scan line. This is used to
8116 eliminate error messages that are occasionally produced by
8117 @command{inc}@footnote{See the section
8118 @uref{@value{MH-BOOK-HOME}/reapre.html, Reading Mail: inc show next
8119 prev} in the MH book.} or @command{scan} (default: @code{"^ *[0-9]"}).
8122 Next, many variables control how the scan lines are parsed.
8125 @vindex mh-folder-body
8126 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8127 @item mh-scan-body-regexp
8128 This regular expression matches the message body fragment. Note that
8129 the default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects
8130 this expression to contain at least one parenthesized expression which
8131 matches the body text as in the default of
8132 @code{"\\(<<\\([^\n]+\\)?\\)"}. If this regular expression is not
8133 correct, the body fragment will not be highlighted with the face
8134 @code{mh-folder-body}.
8135 @c -------------------------
8136 @vindex mh-folder-cur-msg-number
8137 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8139 @item mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp
8140 This regular expression matches the current message. It must match
8141 from the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8142 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8143 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8144 as in the default of @w{@code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\+\\).*"}}. This
8145 expression includes the leading space and current message marker
8146 @samp{+} within the parenthesis since it looks better to highlight
8147 these items as well. The highlighting is done with the face
8148 @code{mh-folder-cur-msg-number}. This regular expression should be
8149 correct as it is needed by non-fontification functions. See also
8151 @c -------------------------
8152 @vindex mh-folder-date
8153 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8154 @vindex mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
8155 @item mh-scan-date-regexp
8156 This regular expression matches a valid date. It must @strong{not} be
8157 anchored to the beginning or the end of the line. Note that the
8158 default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this
8159 expression to contain only one parenthesized expression which matches
8160 the date field as in the default of
8161 @code{"\\([0-9][0-9]/[0-9][0-9]\\)"}. If this regular expression is
8162 not correct, the date will not be highlighted with the face
8163 @code{mh-folder-date}.
8164 @c -------------------------
8165 @vindex mh-folder-deleted
8166 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8167 @vindex mh-note-deleted
8168 @item mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp
8169 This regular expression matches deleted messages. It must match from
8170 the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8171 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8172 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8173 as in the default of @code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\)D"}. This expression
8174 includes the leading space within the parenthesis since it looks
8175 better to highlight it as well. The highlighting is done with the face
8176 @code{mh-folder-deleted}. This regular expression should be correct as
8177 it is needed by non-fontification functions. See also
8178 @code{mh-note-deleted}.
8179 @c -------------------------
8180 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8181 @vindex mh-folder-msg-number
8182 @item mh-scan-good-msg-regexp
8183 This regular expression matches ``good'' messages. It must match from
8184 the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8185 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8186 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8187 as in the default of @w{@code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\)[^D^0-9]"}}. This
8188 expression includes the leading space within the parenthesis since it
8189 looks better to highlight it as well. The highlighting is done with
8190 the face @code{mh-folder-msg-number}. This regular expression should
8191 be correct as it is needed by non-fontification functions.
8192 @c -------------------------
8193 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8194 @item mh-scan-msg-format-regexp
8195 This regular expression finds the message number width in a scan
8196 format. Note that the message number must be placed in a parenthesized
8197 expression as in the default of @code{"%\\([0-9]*\\)(msg)"}. This
8198 variable is only consulted if @code{mh-scan-format-file} is set to
8199 @samp{Use MH-E scan Format}.
8200 @c -------------------------
8201 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8202 @item mh-scan-msg-format-string
8203 This is a format string for the width of the message number in a scan
8204 format. Use @samp{0%d} for zero-filled message numbers. This variable
8205 is only consulted if @code{mh-scan-format-file} is set to @samp{Use
8206 MH-E scan Format} (default: @code{"%d"}).
8207 @c -------------------------
8208 @item mh-scan-msg-number-regexp
8209 This regular expression extracts the message number. It must match
8210 from the beginning of the line. Note that the message number must be
8211 placed in a parenthesized expression as in the default of @w{@code{"^
8213 @c -------------------------
8214 @item mh-scan-msg-overflow-regexp
8215 This regular expression matches overflowed message numbers (default:
8216 @code{"^[?0-9][0-9]"}).
8217 @c -------------------------
8218 @item mh-scan-msg-search-regexp
8219 This regular expression matches a particular message. It is a format
8220 string; use @samp{%d} to represent the location of the message number
8221 within the expression as in the default of @code{"^[^0-9]*%d[^0-9]"}.
8222 @c -------------------------
8223 @vindex mh-folder-address
8224 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8225 @vindex mh-folder-to
8226 @item mh-scan-rcpt-regexp
8227 This regular expression specifies the recipient in messages you sent.
8228 Note that the default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords}
8229 expects this expression to contain two parenthesized expressions. The
8230 first is expected to match the @samp{To:} that the default scan format
8231 file generates. The second is expected to match the recipient's name
8232 as in the default of @code{"\\(To:\\)\\(..............\\)"}. If this
8233 regular expression is not correct, the @samp{To:} string will not be
8234 highlighted with the face @code{mh-folder-to} and the recipient will not be
8235 highlighted with the face @code{mh-folder-address}.
8236 @c -------------------------
8237 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8238 @vindex mh-folder-refiled
8239 @vindex mh-note-refiled
8240 @item mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp
8241 This regular expression matches refiled messages. It must match from
8242 the beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8243 @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8244 at least one parenthesized expression which matches the message number
8245 as in the default of @w{@code{"^\\( *[0-9]+\\)\\^"}}. This expression
8246 includes the leading space within the parenthesis since it looks
8247 better to highlight it as well. The highlighting is done with the face
8248 @code{mh-folder-refiled}. This regular expression should be correct as
8249 it is needed by non-fontification functions. See also
8250 @code{mh-note-refiled}.
8251 @c -------------------------
8252 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8253 @vindex mh-folder-sent-to-me-sender
8254 @vindex mh-mh-folder-sent-to-me-hint
8255 @vindex mh-scan-format-nmh
8256 @item mh-scan-sent-to-me-sender-regexp
8257 This regular expression matches messages sent to us. Note that the
8258 default setting of @code{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this
8259 expression to contain at least two parenthesized expressions. The
8260 first should match the fontification hint (see
8261 @code{mh-scan-format-nmh}) and the second should match the user name
8262 as in the default of
8263 @w{@code{"^ *[0-9]+.\\([bct]\\).....[ ]*\\(..................\\)"}}.
8264 If this regular expression is not correct, the notation hints will not
8265 be highlighted with the face @code{mh-mh-folder-sent-to-me-hint} and
8266 the sender will not be highlighted with the face
8267 @code{mh-folder-sent-to-me-sender}.
8268 @c -------------------------
8269 @vindex mh-folder-followup
8270 @vindex mh-folder-font-lock-keywords
8271 @vindex mh-folder-subject
8272 @item mh-scan-subject-regexp
8273 This regular expression matches the subject. It must match from the
8274 beginning of the line. Note that the default setting of
8275 @samp{mh-folder-font-lock-keywords} expects this expression to contain
8276 at least three parenthesized expressions. The first is expected to
8277 match the @samp{Re:} string, if any, and is highlighted with the face
8278 @code{mh-folder-followup}. The second matches an optional bracketed
8279 number after @samp{Re:}, such as in @samp{Re[2]:} (and is thus a
8280 sub-expression of the first expression). The third is expected to
8281 match the subject line itself which is highlighted with the face
8282 @code{mh-folder-subject}. For example, the default is
8283 @w{@code{"^ *[0-9]+........[ ]*...................}}@*
8284 @w{@code{\\([Rr][Ee]\\(\\[[0-9]+\\]\\)?:\\s-*\\)*\\([^<\n]*\\)"}}.
8285 This regular expression should be correct as it is needed by
8286 non-fontification functions. Note that this example is broken up on
8287 two lines for readability, but is actually a single string.
8290 Finally, there are a slew of variables that control how MH-E annotates
8294 @findex mh-set-cmd-note
8295 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
8297 Column for notations (default: 4). This variable should be set with
8298 the function @code{mh-set-cmd-note}. This variable may be updated
8299 dynamically if @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag} is on. The following
8300 variables contain the notational characters. Note that columns in
8302 @c -------------------------
8303 @item mh-note-copied
8304 Messages that have been copied are marked by this character (default:
8306 @c -------------------------
8307 @vindex mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp
8309 The current message (in MH, not in MH-E) is marked by this character
8310 (default: @code{?+}). See also @code{mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp}.
8311 @c -------------------------
8312 @vindex mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp
8313 @item mh-note-deleted
8314 Messages that have been deleted are marked by this character (default:
8315 @code{?D}). See also @code{mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp}.
8316 @c -------------------------
8318 Messages that have been redistributed are marked by this character
8319 (default: @code{?R}).
8320 @c -------------------------
8322 Messages that have been forwarded are marked by this character
8323 (default: @code{?F}).
8324 @c -------------------------
8325 @item mh-note-printed
8326 Messages that have been printed are marked by this character (default:
8328 @c -------------------------
8329 @vindex mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp
8330 @item mh-note-refiled
8331 Messages that have been refiled are marked by this character (default:
8332 @code{?^}). See also @code{mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp}.
8333 @c -------------------------
8335 Messages that have been replied to are marked by this character
8336 (default: @code{?-}).
8337 @c -------------------------
8339 Messages in a user-defined sequence are marked by this character
8340 (default: @code{?%}). Messages in the @samp{search} sequence are
8341 marked by this character as well.
8344 For example, let's say I have the following in @file{scan.format}
8345 which displays the sender, the subject, and the message number. This
8346 format places a @samp{+} after the message number for the current
8347 message according to MH; it also uses that column for notations.
8350 %20(decode(friendly@{from@})) %50(decode@{subject@}) %4(msg)%<(cur)+%| %>
8353 @vindex mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag
8354 @vindex mh-scan-format-file
8355 @vindex mh-scan-format-file, example
8357 The first thing you have to do is tell MH-E to use this file.
8358 Customize @code{mh-scan-format-file} and set its value to @samp{Use
8359 Default scan Format}. If you didn't get already turn off
8360 @code{mh-adaptive-cmd-note-flag}, you'll need to do that first.
8362 Next, tell MH-E what a valid scan line looks like so that you can at
8363 least display the output of scan in your MH-Folder buffer.
8365 @vindex mh-scan-valid-regexp, example
8368 (setq mh-scan-valid-regexp "[0-9]+[+D^ ]$")
8371 Now, in order to get rid of the @samp{Cursor not pointing to message}
8372 message, you need to tell MH-E how to access the message number. You
8373 should also see why MH-E requires that you include a message number in
8376 @vindex mh-scan-msg-number-regexp, example
8377 @vindex mh-scan-msg-search-regexp, example
8380 (setq mh-scan-msg-number-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)[+D^ ]$")
8381 (setq mh-scan-msg-search-regexp " %d[+D^ ]$")
8384 In order to get the next and previous commands working, add this.
8386 @vindex mh-scan-good-msg-regexp, example
8389 (setq mh-scan-good-msg-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)[+D^ ]$")
8392 Note that the current message isn't marked with a @samp{+} when moving
8393 between the next and previous messages. Here is the code required to
8396 @vindex set-mh-cmd-note, example
8397 @vindex mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp, example
8400 (set-mh-cmd-note 76)
8401 (setq mh-scan-cur-msg-number-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)\\+$")
8404 Finally, add the following to delete and refile messages.
8406 @vindex mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp, example
8407 @vindex mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp, example
8410 (setq mh-scan-deleted-msg-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)D$")
8411 (setq mh-scan-refiled-msg-regexp "^.* \\([0-9]+\\)\\^$")
8414 This is just a bare minimum; it's best to adjust all of the regular
8415 expressions to ensure that MH-E and highlighting perform well.
8417 @node Procmail, Odds and Ends, Scan Line Formats, Top
8418 @appendix Reading Mailing Lists Effectively
8420 @cindex @command{procmail}
8421 @cindex @command{slocal}
8423 @cindex MH commands, @command{slocal}
8424 @cindex Unix commands, @command{procmail}
8425 @cindex mailing lists, reading
8427 This appendix explains how to use @uref{http://www.procmail.org/,
8428 procmail} to file mail from mailing lists into folders which can then
8429 be read easily with MH-E@footnote{The MH equivalent, @command{slocal},
8430 can be used as well, but procmail is more flexible and more packages
8431 exist for procmail than for slocal.}. Some mailing lists have such
8432 high traffic that Gnus must be used and I discuss how to use Gnus
8433 side-by-side with MH-E.
8435 @cindex @file{.procmailrc}
8436 @cindex files, @file{.procmailrc}
8438 First, I'll describe how to put mail from your mailing lists directly
8439 into an MH folder using @command{procmail}. First, add the following
8440 to @file{~/.procmailrc}. While the logging variables aren't strictly
8441 necessary, they are extremely useful.
8444 [1] # Update PATH so procmail can find myrcvstore, rcvstore and mhparam.
8445 [2] PATH=$PATH:/usr/lib/mh:/usr/bin/mh:$HOME/bin
8447 [4] # Point LOGFILE at the actual log file.
8448 [5] LOGFILE=$HOME/.procmail.log
8450 [7] # This setting provides just the right amount of information.
8453 [10] # Uncomment the following line to see how your patterns match.
8456 [13] # Place mail sent to any MH-E mailing list in +mh-e.
8457 [14] :0 w: mh-e$LOCKEXT
8458 [15] * ^TO.*mh-e-.*@.*sourceforge.net
8459 [16] | myrcvstore -create +mh-e
8462 @cindex @command{rcvstore}
8463 @cindex MH commands, @command{rcvstore}
8465 Line 14 creates a lock file in your mail directory based upon the name
8466 of the folder. This is done because @command{rcvstore} does not
8467 perform locking. While this lock file will prevent @command{procmail}
8468 from writing to a folder concurrently, there is a slight chance that
8469 you might lose a message if you're performing operations on a folder
8470 at the same time @command{rcvstore} is placing a message there. You
8471 have been warned. Now that that disclaimer is out of the way, note
8472 that I've been using this set-up for over a decade and haven't lost
8473 anything to my knowledge@footnote{See
8474 @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/bugs/?func=detailbug&bug_id=4361&group_id=2166,
8475 Savannah issue #4361} to see if @command{rcvstore} locking is still an
8478 @cindex @samp{Unseen-Sequence:} MH profile component
8479 @cindex MH profile component, @samp{Unseen-Sequence:}
8481 Line 16 uses the following script, @code{myrcvstore}, to massage the
8482 message as described in the comment and file the message in the given
8483 folder@footnote{The @samp{-create} argument wasn't always the default
8484 to @command{rcvstore}.}.
8489 # Accepts a message on standard input and passes it through rcvstore
8490 # after first passing it through any filters. All arguments are passed
8493 # Force the "From user date" to become part of header. One reason this
8494 # is done is because the presence of the From field confuses dist so
8495 # that dist adds a new header, rather than using the existing header.
8496 # Note that this should not be done for any message that goes into a
8497 # Gnus incoming file (Gnus will thrown an error) nor should it be
8498 # applied to any message that goes to the system mailbox because the
8499 # entire mailbox will be incorporated as a single message.
8500 formail -c -z -R 'From ' X-Envelope-From: |
8504 If your version of @command{rcvstore} doesn't add messages to the
8505 @samp{unseen} sequence by default, add the following line to your MH
8509 Unseen-Sequence: unseen
8512 Now view your new messages with the speedbar (@pxref{Speedbar}) or with
8513 @kbd{F n} (@code{mh-index-new-messages}). @xref{Folders}.
8515 If you're on a mailing list that is so voluminous that it is
8516 impossible to read every message, it usually better to read the
8517 mailing list like a newsgroup in a news reader. Emacs has a built-in
8518 newsreader called Gnus. The remainder of this appendix talks about how
8519 to use Gnus with an MH message store. The version of Gnus that was
8520 used to prepare this manual was 5.10. Versions 5.8 through 5.10 should
8521 work but versions prior to 5.8 use different options.
8523 This table contains a list of Gnus options that you will have to
8524 modify. Note that for them to become accessible, you'll have to load
8525 @file{nnml.el} first. This can be done with @kbd{M-x load-library
8526 @key{RET} nnml @key{RET}}.
8529 @item gnus-secondary-select-methods
8530 Select the @samp{nnml} value. This select method uses directories for
8531 folders and individual files for messages, just like MH. You do not
8532 have to set an address.
8533 @c -------------------------
8535 Select the @samp{Several files in a directory} value, check the
8536 @samp{Path} box and enter @file{~/Mail} to tell Gnus where to find
8538 @c -------------------------
8539 @vindex mail-user-agent
8540 @item message-mail-user-agent
8541 In order to send mail within Gnus using MH-E, set this option to
8542 @samp{mail-user-agent} and set the @code{mail-user-agent} option to
8543 @samp{Emacs interface to MH}.
8544 @c -------------------------
8545 @item nnmail-keep-last-article
8546 Since Gnus keeps track of which messages you have read, it would be
8547 bad if Gnus expired the last message, for example, message 100, and
8548 @command{rcvstore} gave the next new message number 1. Gnus would then
8549 ignore it since it thinks that you've read messages 1-100. Turning on
8550 this option ensures that the last message is never removed thereby
8551 eliminating this problem.
8554 Next add the following to @file{~/.procmailrc}. If you don't subscribe
8555 to the GnuCash mailing list, substitute one to which you are
8559 PATH=$PATH:/usr/bin/mh
8560 MAILDIR=$HOME/`mhparam Path`
8561 # Place mail sent to the GnuCash mailing list in gnucash.spool, where
8562 # Gnus will pick it up.
8564 * ^TO.*gnucash.*@.*gnucash.org
8568 Wait for some messages to appear in @file{gnucash.spool} and run Gnus
8569 with @kbd{M-x gnus @key{RET}}. To view the folder created in the
8570 example above, you would tell Gnus about it the first time only with
8571 @kbd{G m gnucash @key{RET} nnml @key{RET}}. In MH-E, this folder is
8572 known as @samp{+gnucash}.
8574 @node Odds and Ends, History, Procmail, Top
8575 @appendix Odds and Ends
8577 This appendix covers a few topics that don't fit elsewhere. Here I
8578 tell you how to report bugs and how to get on the MH-E mailing lists.
8579 I also point out some additional sources of information.
8584 * MH FAQ and Support::
8588 @node Bug Reports, Mailing Lists, Odds and Ends, Odds and Ends
8589 @appendixsec Bug Reports
8593 @kindex M-x mh-version
8595 Bug reports should be filed at
8596 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/tracker/?group_id=13357&atid=113357,
8597 SourceForge}. You need to be a SourceForge user to submit bug reports,
8598 but this is easy enough to do that it shouldn't be a restriction for
8599 you. Please include the output of @kbd{M-x mh-version}
8600 (@pxref{Miscellaneous}) in any bug report you send unless you're 110%
8601 positive we won't ask for it.
8603 @node Mailing Lists, MH FAQ and Support, Bug Reports, Odds and Ends
8604 @appendixsec MH-E Mailing Lists
8607 @cindex mailing lists
8609 There are several mailing lists for MH-E. They are @i{mh-e-users at
8610 lists.sourceforge.net}, @i{mh-e-announce at lists.sourceforge.net},
8611 and @i{mh-e-devel at lists.sourceforge.net}. You can subscribe or view
8612 the archives at @uref{https://sourceforge.net/mail/?group_id=13357,
8613 SourceForge}. Do not report bugs on these lists; please submit them
8614 via SourceForge (@pxref{Bug Reports}).
8616 @node MH FAQ and Support, Getting MH-E, Mailing Lists, Odds and Ends
8617 @appendixsec MH FAQ and Support
8622 The article @uref{http://www.newt.com/faq/mh.html, @cite{MH Frequently
8623 Asked Questions (FAQ) with Answers}} appears monthly in the newsgroup
8624 @samp{comp.mail.mh}. While very little is there that deals with MH-E
8625 specifically, there is an incredible wealth of material about MH
8626 itself which you will find useful.
8630 You can find FAQs on MH-E at the
8631 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/tracker/?group_id=13357&atid=213357,
8632 Support Requests} page on SourceForge. If you don't find the answer to
8633 your question, file a support request and your question will become a
8636 @node Getting MH-E, , MH FAQ and Support, Odds and Ends
8637 @appendixsec Getting MH-E
8639 @cindex MH-E, obtaining
8640 @cindex getting MH-E
8641 @cindex obtaining MH-E
8643 Because MH-E is undergoing a phase of sustained growth, the version of
8644 MH-E in your Emacs is likely to be out of date although it is most
8645 likely to be more up to date than the copy that comes with the MH
8646 distribution in @file{miscellany/mh-e}.
8649 @cindex release notes
8651 New MH-E releases are always available for downloading at
8652 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/project/showfiles.php?group_id=13357,
8653 SourceForge} before they appear in an Emacs release. You can read the
8654 release notes on that page to determine if the given release of MH-E
8655 is already installed in your version of Emacs. You can also read the
8656 change log to see if you are interested in what the given release of
8657 MH-E has to offer (although we have no doubt that you will be
8658 extremely interested in all new releases).
8662 If you use Debian, you can install the Debian
8663 @uref{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/mail/mh-e, mh-e package}
8666 @cindex files, @samp{MH-E-NEWS}
8667 @cindex files, @samp{README}
8669 @cindex @samp{MH-E-NEWS}
8670 @cindex @samp{README}
8671 @kindex M-x mh-version
8673 After you download and extract the MH-E tarball, read the
8674 @file{README} file and @file{MH-E-NEWS}. These correspond to the
8675 release notes and change log mentioned above. The file @file{README}
8676 contains instructions on installing MH-E. If you're already running
8677 Emacs, please quit that session and start again to load in the new
8678 MH-E. Check that you're running the new version with the command
8679 @kbd{M-x mh-version}.
8681 @cindex contributed software
8683 @cindex documentation
8685 In addition to the mh-e package, the
8686 @uref{https://sourceforge.net/project/showfiles.php?group_id=13357,
8687 SourceForge} site also contains doc and contrib packages. The former
8688 is the latest release of this manual, and the latter contains a few
8689 contributed packages you might find useful.
8691 @node History, GFDL, Odds and Ends, Top
8692 @appendix History of MH-E
8696 @cindex Gildea, Stephen
8699 @cindex MH-E, versions
8702 @cindex Stephen Gildea
8703 @cindex Wohler, Bill
8704 @cindex history of MH-E
8705 @cindex versions of MH-E
8707 MH-E was originally written by Brian Reid in 1983 and has changed
8708 hands several times since then. Jim Larus wanted to do something
8709 similar for GNU Emacs, and ended up completely rewriting it that same
8710 year. In 1989, Stephen Gildea picked it up and added many
8711 improvements. Bill Wohler then took over in 2000 and moved its
8712 development to @uref{http://sourceforge.net/, SourceForge} where it
8718 * From Stephen Gildea::
8719 * From Bill Wohler::
8722 @node From Brian Reid, From Jim Larus, History, History
8723 @appendixsec From Brian Reid
8728 One day in 1983 I got the flu and had to stay home from work for three
8729 days with nothing to do. I used that time to write MHE@. The
8730 fundamental idea behind MHE was that it was a ``puppeteer'' driving
8731 the MH programs underneath it. MH had a model that the editor was
8732 supposed to run as a sub-process of the mailer, which seemed to me at
8733 the time to be the tail wagging the dog. So I turned it around and
8734 made the editor drive the MH programs. I made sure that the UCI people
8735 (who were maintaining MH at the time) took in my changes and made them
8738 Today, I still use my own version of MHE because I don't at all like
8739 the way that GNU MH-E works and I've never gotten to be good enough at
8740 hacking Emacs Lisp to make GNU MH-E do what I want. The Gosling-emacs
8741 version of MHE and the GNU Emacs version of MH-E have almost nothing
8742 in common except similar names. They work differently, have different
8743 conceptual models, and have different key bindings@footnote{After
8744 reading this article, I questioned Brian about his version of MHE, and
8745 received some great ideas for improving MH-E such as a dired-like
8746 method of selecting folders; and removing the prompting when sending
8747 mail, filling in the blanks in the draft buffer instead. I passed them
8748 on to Stephen Gildea, the current maintainer, and he was excited about
8749 the ideas as well. Perhaps one day, MH-E will again resemble MHE
8750 (draft form editing was introduced in version 7.4).}.
8752 Brian Reid, June 1994
8754 @node From Jim Larus, From Stephen Gildea, From Brian Reid, History
8755 @appendixsec From Jim Larus
8760 Brian Reid, while at CMU or shortly after going to Stanford wrote a
8761 mail reading program called MHE for Gosling Emacs. It had much the
8762 same structure as MH-E (i.e., invoked MH programs), though it was
8763 simpler and the commands were slightly different. Unfortunately, I no
8764 longer have a copy so the differences are lost in the mists of time.
8766 In '82-83, I was working at BBN and wrote a lot of mlisp code in
8767 Gosling Emacs to make it look more like Tennex Emacs. One of the
8768 packages that I picked up and improved was Reid's mail system. In '83,
8769 I went back to Berkeley. About that time, Stallman's first version of
8770 GNU Emacs came out and people started to move to it from Gosling Emacs
8771 (as I recall, the transition took a year or two). I decided to port
8772 Reid's MHE and used the mlisp to Emacs Lisp translator that came with
8773 GNU Emacs. It did a lousy job and the resulting code didn't work, so I
8774 bit the bullet and rewrote the code by hand (it was a lot smaller and
8775 simpler then, so it took only a day or two).
8777 Soon after that, MH-E became part of the standard Emacs distribution
8778 and suggestions kept dribbling in for improvements. MH-E soon reached
8779 sufficient functionality to keep me happy, but I kept on improving it
8780 because I was a graduate student with plenty of time on my hands and
8781 it was more fun than my dissertation. In retrospect, the one thing
8782 that I regret is not writing any documentation, which seriously
8783 limited the use and appeal of the package.
8785 @cindex @command{xmh}, in MH-E history
8787 In '89, I came to Wisconsin as a professor and decided not to work on
8788 MH-E. It was stable, except for minor bugs, and had enough
8789 functionality, so I let it be for a few years. Stephen Gildea of BBN
8790 began to pester me about the bugs, but I ignored them. In 1990, he
8791 went off to the X Consortium, said good bye, and said that he would
8792 now be using @command{xmh}. A few months later, he came back and said
8793 that he couldn't stand @command{xmh} and could I put a few more bug fixes
8794 into MH-E. At that point, I had no interest in fixing MH-E, so I gave
8795 the responsibility of maintenance to him and he has done a fine job
8798 Jim Larus, June 1994
8800 @node From Stephen Gildea, From Bill Wohler, From Jim Larus, History
8801 @appendixsec From Stephen Gildea
8803 @cindex Gildea, Stephen
8804 @cindex Stephen Gildea
8806 In 1987 I went to work for Bolt Beranek and Newman, as Jim had before
8807 me. In my previous job, I had been using RMAIL, but as my folders tend
8808 to run large, I was frustrated with the speed of RMAIL@. However, I
8809 stuck with it because I wanted the GNU Emacs interface. I am very
8810 familiar and comfortable with the Emacs interface (with just a few
8811 modifications of my own) and dislike having to use applications with
8812 embedded editors; they never live up to Emacs.
8814 MH is the mail reader of choice at BBN, so I converted to it. Since I
8815 didn't want to give up using an Emacs interface, I started using MH-E.
8816 As is my wont, I started hacking on it almost immediately. I first
8817 used version 3.4m. One of the first features I added was to treat the
8818 folder buffer as a file-visiting buffer: you could lock it, save it,
8819 and be warned of unsaved changes when killing it. I also worked to
8820 bring its functionality a little closer to RMAIL@. Jim Larus was very
8821 cooperative about merging in my changes, and my efforts first appeared
8822 in version 3.6, distributed with Emacs 18.52 in 1988. Next I decided
8823 MH-E was too slow and optimized it a lot. Version, 3.7, distributed
8824 with Emacs 18.56 in 1990, was noticeably faster.
8826 When I moved to the X Consortium I became the first person there to
8827 not use xmh. (There is now one other engineer there using MH-E.) About
8828 this point I took over maintenance of MH-E from Jim and was finally
8829 able to add some features Jim hadn't accepted, such as the backward
8830 searching undo. My first release was 3.8 (Emacs 18.58) in 1992.
8832 Now, in 1994, we see a flurry of releases, with both 4.0 and 5.0.
8833 Version 4.0 added many new features, including background folder
8834 collection and support for composing @sc{mime} messages. (Reading
8835 @sc{mime} messages remains to be done, alas.) While writing this book,
8836 Bill Wohler gave MH-E its closest examination ever, uncovering bugs
8837 and inconsistencies that required a new major version to fix, and so
8838 version 5 was released.
8840 Stephen Gildea, June 1994
8842 @node From Bill Wohler, , From Stephen Gildea, History
8843 @appendixsec From Bill Wohler
8845 @cindex Wohler, Bill
8848 The preface originally included the following text which I use to
8852 But it's important to note a brief history of MH-E.
8854 @w{Version 3} was prevalent through the @w{Emacs 18} and early
8855 @w{Emacs 19} years. Then @w{Version 4} came out (@w{Emacs 19.23}),
8856 which introduced several new and changed commands. Next, @w{Version
8857 5.0} was released, which fixed some bugs and incompatibilities, and
8858 was incorporated into @w{Emacs 19.29}.
8861 After a long break, Stephen handed the reins over to me in 2000. I
8862 moved the project to a new site called SourceForge and organized a
8863 great team of developers. Our first release in late 2001 was version
8864 6. It appeared around the time of Emacs 21.2 and had menus and tool
8867 Then, indexed searches, improved MIME handling, a speedbar, multiple
8868 identities, alias completion, an index view of unseen messages, spam
8869 software support, Face and X-Image-URL header field support, Fcc
8870 completion, arbitrary range handling, and draft form editing were
8871 introduced in the version 7 series around the time of Emacs 21.4
8872 (2004). Still, Emacs itself contained version 5 of MH-E released back
8875 Version 8 development was mostly driven by the rewrite of the manual.
8876 It also brought mailutils support, S/MIME support, picon support, and
8877 an improved interface for hiding header fields. The CVS repository was
8878 migrated from SourceForge to Savannah (only for those files that were
8879 already part of Emacs) and the software was completely reorganized to
8880 push back two decades of entropy. Version 8 will appear in Emacs 22.1,
8881 expected to be released in 2006.
8883 Bill Wohler, February 2006
8885 @node GFDL, GPL, History, Top
8886 @appendix GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE
8887 @center Version 1.2, November 2002
8890 Copyright (C) 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8891 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
8893 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
8894 of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
8901 The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
8902 functional and useful document ``free'' in the sense of freedom: to
8903 assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
8904 with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially.
8905 Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way
8906 to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible
8907 for modifications made by others.
8909 This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative
8910 works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
8911 complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
8912 license designed for free software.
8914 We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
8915 software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
8916 program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
8917 software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
8918 it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
8919 whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
8920 principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
8924 APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
8926 This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that
8927 contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
8928 distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a
8929 world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that
8930 work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below,
8931 refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a
8932 licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you
8933 copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission
8934 under copyright law.
8936 A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the
8937 Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
8938 modifications and/or translated into another language.
8940 A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section of
8941 the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
8942 publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject
8943 (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly
8944 within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a
8945 textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any
8946 mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
8947 connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
8948 commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
8951 The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
8952 are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
8953 that says that the Document is released under this License. If a
8954 section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not
8955 allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero
8956 Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant
8957 Sections then there are none.
8959 The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed,
8960 as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
8961 the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may
8962 be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
8964 A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
8965 represented in a format whose specification is available to the
8966 general public, that is suitable for revising the document
8967 straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
8968 pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
8969 drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
8970 for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
8971 to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
8972 format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart
8973 or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent.
8974 An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount
8975 of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque.''
8978 Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
8979 ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML
8980 or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple
8981 HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of
8982 transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats
8983 include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by
8984 proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or
8985 processing tools are not generally available, and the
8986 machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word
8987 processors for output purposes only.
8989 The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
8990 plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
8991 this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
8992 formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means
8993 the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
8994 preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
8996 A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose
8997 title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following
8998 text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a
8999 specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'',
9000 ``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To ``Preserve the Title''
9001 of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
9002 section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition.
9004 The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which
9005 states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty
9006 Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this
9007 License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
9008 implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has
9009 no effect on the meaning of this License.
9014 You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
9015 commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
9016 copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
9017 to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
9018 conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
9019 technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
9020 copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
9021 compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
9022 number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
9024 You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
9025 you may publicly display copies.
9030 If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have
9031 printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the
9032 Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
9033 copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
9034 Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
9035 the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
9036 you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
9037 the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
9038 visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
9039 Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
9040 the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
9041 as verbatim copying in other respects.
9043 If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
9044 legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
9045 reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
9048 If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
9049 more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
9050 copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
9051 a computer-network location from which the general network-using
9052 public has access to download using public-standard network protocols
9053 a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material.
9054 If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps,
9055 when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure
9056 that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
9057 location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an
9058 Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
9059 edition to the public.
9061 It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
9062 Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
9063 them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
9068 You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
9069 the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release
9070 the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
9071 Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
9072 and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
9073 of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
9075 A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
9076 from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
9077 (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
9078 of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
9079 if the original publisher of that version gives permission.@*
9080 B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
9081 responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
9082 Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
9083 Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five),
9084 unless they release you from this requirement.@*
9085 C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
9086 Modified Version, as the publisher.@*
9087 D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.@*
9088 E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
9089 adjacent to the other copyright notices.@*
9090 F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
9091 giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
9092 terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.@*
9093 G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
9094 and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.@*
9095 H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.@*
9096 I. Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add
9097 to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
9098 publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
9099 there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one
9100 stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
9101 given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
9102 Version as stated in the previous sentence.@*
9103 J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
9104 public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
9105 the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
9106 it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section.
9107 You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
9108 least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
9109 publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.@*
9110 K. For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'',
9111 Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all
9112 the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements
9113 and/or dedications given therein.@*
9114 L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
9115 unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
9116 or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.@*
9117 M. Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements.'' Such a section
9118 may not be included in the Modified Version.@*
9119 N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements''
9120 or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.@*
9121 O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.@*
9123 If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
9124 appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
9125 copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
9126 of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
9127 list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
9128 These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
9130 You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains
9131 nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
9132 parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
9133 been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
9136 You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
9137 passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
9138 of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
9139 Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
9140 through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
9141 includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
9142 by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
9143 you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
9144 permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
9146 The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
9147 give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
9148 imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
9153 You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
9154 License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified
9155 versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
9156 Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
9157 list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
9158 license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
9160 The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
9161 multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
9162 copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
9163 different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
9164 adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
9165 author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
9166 Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
9167 Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
9169 In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History''
9170 in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled
9171 ``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
9172 and any sections Entitled ``Dedications.'' You must delete all sections
9173 Entitled ``Endorsements.''
9176 COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
9178 You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
9179 released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
9180 License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
9181 the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
9182 verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
9184 You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
9185 it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
9186 License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
9187 other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
9190 AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
9192 A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
9193 and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
9194 distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright
9195 resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights
9196 of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit.
9197 When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not
9198 apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves
9199 derivative works of the Document.
9201 If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
9202 copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of
9203 the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
9204 covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
9205 electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form.
9206 Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
9212 Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
9213 distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4.
9214 Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
9215 permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
9216 translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
9217 original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
9218 translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
9219 Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include
9220 the original English version of this License and the original versions
9221 of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between
9222 the translation and the original version of this License or a notice
9223 or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
9225 If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
9226 ``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement (section 4) to Preserve
9227 its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual
9233 You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except
9234 as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to
9235 copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will
9236 automatically terminate your rights under this License. However,
9237 parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this
9238 License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
9239 parties remain in full compliance.
9242 FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
9244 The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
9245 of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
9246 versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
9247 differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
9248 http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
9250 Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
9251 If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
9252 License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of
9253 following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
9254 of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
9255 Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
9256 number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
9257 as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
9261 @unnumberedsec ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
9263 To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
9264 the License in the document and put the following copyright and
9265 license notices just after the title page:
9269 Copyright (C) @var{year} @var{your name}.
9270 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
9271 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2
9272 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
9273 with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts.
9274 A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
9275 Free Documentation License''.
9279 If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts,
9280 replace the ``with...Texts.'' line with this:
9284 with the Invariant Sections being @var{list their titles}, with the
9285 Front-Cover Texts being @var{list}, and with the Back-Cover Texts being
9290 If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
9291 combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
9294 If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
9295 recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
9296 free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
9297 to permit their use in free software.
9299 @node GPL, Key Index, GFDL, Top
9300 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
9301 @center Version 2, June 1991
9304 Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9305 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA
9307 Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
9308 of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
9311 @unnumberedsec Preamble
9313 The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
9314 freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
9315 License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
9316 software---to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
9317 General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
9318 Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
9319 using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
9320 the GNU Lesser General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
9323 When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
9324 price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
9325 have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
9326 this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
9327 if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
9328 in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
9330 To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
9331 anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
9332 These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
9333 distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
9335 For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
9336 gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
9337 you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
9338 source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
9341 We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
9342 (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
9343 distribute and/or modify the software.
9345 Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
9346 that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
9347 software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
9348 want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
9349 that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
9350 authors' reputations.
9352 Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
9353 patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
9354 program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
9355 program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
9356 patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
9358 The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
9359 modification follow.
9362 @unnumberedsec TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
9365 @center TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
9370 This License applies to any program or other work which contains
9371 a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
9372 under the terms of this General Public License. The ``Program,'' below,
9373 refers to any such program or work, and a ``work based on the Program''
9374 means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
9375 that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
9376 either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
9377 language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
9378 the term ``modification.'') Each licensee is addressed as ``you.''
9380 Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
9381 covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
9382 running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
9383 is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
9384 Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
9385 Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
9388 You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
9389 source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
9390 conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
9391 copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
9392 notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
9393 and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
9394 along with the Program.
9396 You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
9397 you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
9400 You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
9401 of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
9402 distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
9403 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
9407 You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
9408 stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
9411 You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
9412 whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
9413 part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
9414 parties under the terms of this License.
9417 If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
9418 when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
9419 interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
9420 announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
9421 notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
9422 a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
9423 these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
9424 License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
9425 does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
9426 the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
9429 These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
9430 identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
9431 and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
9432 themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
9433 sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
9434 distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
9435 on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
9436 this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
9437 entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
9439 Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
9440 your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
9441 exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
9442 collective works based on the Program.
9444 In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
9445 with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
9446 a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
9447 the scope of this License.
9450 You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
9451 under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
9452 Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
9456 Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
9457 source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
9458 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
9461 Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
9462 years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
9463 cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
9464 machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
9465 distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
9466 customarily used for software interchange; or,
9469 Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
9470 to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
9471 allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
9472 received the program in object code or executable form with such
9473 an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
9476 The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
9477 making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
9478 code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
9479 associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
9480 control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
9481 special exception, the source code distributed need not include
9482 anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
9483 form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
9484 operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
9485 itself accompanies the executable.
9487 If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
9488 access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
9489 access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
9490 distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
9491 compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
9494 You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
9495 except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
9496 otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
9497 void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
9498 However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
9499 this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
9500 parties remain in full compliance.
9503 You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
9504 signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
9505 distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
9506 prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
9507 modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
9508 Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
9509 all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
9510 the Program or works based on it.
9513 Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
9514 Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
9515 original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
9516 these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
9517 restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
9518 You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
9522 If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
9523 infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
9524 conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
9525 otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
9526 excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
9527 distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
9528 License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
9529 may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
9530 license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
9531 all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
9532 the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
9533 refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
9535 If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
9536 any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
9537 apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
9540 It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
9541 patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
9542 such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
9543 integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
9544 implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
9545 generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
9546 through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
9547 system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
9548 to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
9551 This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
9552 be a consequence of the rest of this License.
9555 If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
9556 certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
9557 original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
9558 may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
9559 those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
9560 countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
9561 the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
9564 The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
9565 of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
9566 be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
9567 address new problems or concerns.
9569 Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
9570 specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and ``any
9571 later version,'' you have the option of following the terms and conditions
9572 either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
9573 Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
9574 this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
9578 If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
9579 programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
9580 to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
9581 Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
9582 make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
9583 of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
9584 of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
9587 @heading NO WARRANTY
9594 BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
9595 FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW@. EXCEPT WHEN
9596 OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
9597 PROVIDE THE PROGRAM ``AS IS'' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
9598 OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
9599 MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE@. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
9600 TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU@. SHOULD THE
9601 PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
9602 REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
9605 IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
9606 WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
9607 REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
9608 INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
9609 OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
9610 TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
9611 YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
9612 PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
9613 POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
9617 @heading END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
9620 @center END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
9624 @unnumberedsec How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
9626 If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
9627 possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
9628 free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
9630 To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
9631 to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
9632 convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
9633 the ``copyright'' line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
9636 @var{one line to give the program's name and an idea of what it does.}
9637 Copyright (C) @var{yyyy} @var{name of author}
9639 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9640 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
9641 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2
9642 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
9644 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
9645 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
9646 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE@. See the
9647 GNU General Public License for more details.
9649 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
9650 with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
9651 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
9654 Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
9656 If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
9657 when it starts in an interactive mode:
9660 Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) @var{yyyy} @var{name of author}
9661 Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details
9662 type `show w'. This is free software, and you are welcome
9663 to redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c'
9667 The hypothetical commands @samp{show w} and @samp{show c} should show
9668 the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, the
9669 commands you use may be called something other than @samp{show w} and
9670 @samp{show c}; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu items---whatever
9673 You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
9674 school, if any, to sign a ``copyright disclaimer'' for the program, if
9675 necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
9679 Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright
9680 interest in the program `Gnomovision'
9681 (which makes passes at compilers) written
9684 @var{signature of Ty Coon}, 1 April 1989
9685 Ty Coon, President of Vice
9689 This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
9690 proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may
9691 consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
9692 library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General
9693 Public License instead of this License.
9695 @node Key Index, Command Index, GPL, Top
9696 @unnumbered Key (Character) Index
9699 @node Command Index, Option Index, Key Index, Top
9700 @unnumbered Command Index
9703 @node Option Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
9704 @unnumbered Option (Variable) Index
9707 @node Concept Index, , Option Index, Top
9708 @unnumbered Concept Index
9715 @c The following are words that ispell should ignore that would not
9716 @c normally be in a dictionary (global or personal). Be careful not to
9717 @c include words here that could potentially be typos of other words
9718 @c (such as url, elisp, or MHE).
9720 @c LocalWords: CTRL ESC SPC f's
9721 @c LocalWords: addr Aliasfile alist
9722 @c LocalWords: Baushke Bcc BBN Beranek bogofilter bogofilter's
9723 @c LocalWords: cmd CMU contrib cron
9724 @c LocalWords: DesBrisay Dcc devel dir dired docstring filll forw
9725 @c LocalWords: GECOS Gildea Gildea's Ginnean GnuCash goto gnuserv htm
9726 @c LocalWords: ImageMagick inbox ispell keychain
9727 @c LocalWords: Larus licensor LocalWords lookup lpr
9728 @c LocalWords: makeinfo mairix mbox mh mhbuild mhl mhpath mlisp
9729 @c LocalWords: MML msg multipart
9730 @c LocalWords: Namazu NIS nenscript nnml num
9731 @c LocalWords: packmbox passphrase pathname prev procmail prog repl
9732 @c LocalWords: slocal sortm SpamAssassin spammers SpamProbe SpamProbe's
9733 @c LocalWords: sublicense supercite speedbar
9734 @c LocalWords: Tennex texi texinfo Thelen thelenm
9735 @c LocalWords: UCI undeleted whatnow wohler xmh ypcat
9737 @c See http://www.oreilly.com/oreilly/author/stylesheet.html.
9738 @c See http://en.wikipedia.org/.
9740 @c Note the lowercase mh which is needed to avoid hits in the
9741 @c functions and variables. Occasionally, check for accidental
9742 @c inclusion of mh in text by uncommenting the following and executing
9743 @c it with C-x C-e. You want to see "Search failed"
9744 @c (let ((case-fold-search nil))
9745 @c (goto-char (point-min))
9746 @c (search-forward-regexp "^mh\\( \\|$\\)"))
9748 @c An extremely useful setting for texinfo-mode-hook is:
9750 @c 'ispell-skip-region-alist
9752 @c (concat "\\(@\\(small\\)?\\(example\\|lisp\\)"
9753 @c "\\(@\\([irw]\\|code\\|var\\){[^}]+}\\|"
9756 @c "@\\(end \\)?group\\|"
9757 @c "@\\(end \\)?cartouche\\)+"
9758 @c "@end \\(small\\)?\\(example\\|lisp\\)\\|"
9759 @c "@\\(code\\|command\\|file\\|kbd\\|sc\\){[^}]+}\\|"
9760 @c "^@end [a-z]+$\\|"
9761 @c "^@\\([fv]\\|print\\)index .*$\\|"
9762 @c "@uref{[^,]+,\\|"
9764 @c "/[a-z.]+[/}]\\)")))))
9768 @c See existing cross-references to the Emacs manual and the Emacs
9769 @c Lisp manual (search for ``GNU Emacs Manual'' and ``GNU
9770 @c Emacs Lisp Reference Manual'' respectively).
9774 @c As per index (sort of): Punctuation, keyboard characters (such as
9775 @c RET and BS) upper and lowercase mixed (lower comes before
9776 @c uppercase), control characters go with uppercase C, meta characters
9777 @c go with uppercase M.
9778 @c In some cases, the sort isn't strictly ASCII.
9779 @c For example, SPC (mh-page-msg) reads better before BS
9780 @c (mh-previous-page) and . (mh-show) is better before ,
9781 @c (mh-header-display).
9785 @c Alphabetical, pull hooks into their own table.
9788 @c sentence-end-double-space: nil
9792 arch-tag: b778477d-1a10-4a99-84de-f877a2ea6bef